blob: 5d0fba02dce1fdbe7b477cb3a33de61bf8f239b7 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau02c7c142012-06-04 00:43:45 +02007 2012/06/04
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100565. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
586. HTTP header manipulation
59
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100607. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200617.1. Matching integers
627.2. Matching strings
637.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200647.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200657.5. Available matching criteria
667.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
677.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
687.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
697.6. Pre-defined ACLs
707.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100717.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072
738. Logging
748.1. Log levels
758.2. Log formats
768.2.1. Default log format
778.2.2. TCP log format
788.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100798.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200808.3. Advanced logging options
818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
828.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
838.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
848.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
858.4. Timing events
868.5. Session state at disconnection
878.6. Non-printable characters
888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
908.9. Examples of logs
91
929. Statistics and monitoring
939.1. CSV format
949.2. Unix Socket commands
95
96
971. Quick reminder about HTTP
98----------------------------
99
100When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
101fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
102on almost anything found in the contents.
103
104However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
105formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
106correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
107
108
1091.1. The HTTP transaction model
110-------------------------------
111
112The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100113to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
115connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
116will involve a new connection :
117
118 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
119
120In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
121establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
122by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
123length.
124
125Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
126to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
127however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
128response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
129header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
130
131 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
132
133Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
134power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
135but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200136a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
138A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
139keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
140second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
141page :
142
143 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
144
145This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
146latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
147correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
148the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100149server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
152connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
153everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
154established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
155sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
156while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
157another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
158sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
159http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
160mode.
161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162
1631.2. HTTP request
164-----------------
165
166First, let's consider this HTTP request :
167
168 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100169 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
171 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
172 3 User-agent: my small browser
173 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
174 5 Accept: image/png
175
176
1771.2.1. The Request line
178-----------------------
179
180Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
181
182 - a METHOD : GET
183 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
184 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
185
186All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
187which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
188followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
189is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
190desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
191the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
192
193The URI itself can have several forms :
194
195 - A "relative URI" :
196
197 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
198
199 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
200 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
201
202 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
203
204 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
207 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
208 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
209 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
210 must accept this form too.
211
212 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
213 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
214 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
217 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
218 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
219 other protocols too.
220
221In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
222mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
223on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
224It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
225specific to the language, framework or application in use.
226
227
2281.2.2. The request headers
229--------------------------
230
231The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
232beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
233an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
234Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
235values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
236encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
237the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
238define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
239
240Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
241their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
242"Connection:" header).
243
244The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
245that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
246is one valid form of empty line.
247
248Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
249headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
250about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
251application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
252
253Important note:
254 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
255 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
256 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
257 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
258
259
2601.3. HTTP response
261------------------
262
263An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
264messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
265
266 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100267 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200268 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
269 2 Content-length: 350
270 3 Content-Type: text/html
271
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200272As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
273codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
274response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100275continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
276the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
277following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
278sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
279(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
280correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
281such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
282state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
283over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
284if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
285information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.3.1. The Response line
289------------------------
290
291Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
292
293 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
294 - a status code : 200
295 - a reason : OK
296
297The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
300 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
301 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
302 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
303
304Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100305"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
307messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
308or "Authentication Required".
309
310Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
311
312 Code When / reason
313 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
314 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
316 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 400 for an invalid or too large request
318 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
319 accessing the stats page)
320 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
321 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
322 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
323 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
324 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
325 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
326 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
327 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
328 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
329
330The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3314.2).
332
333
3341.3.2. The response headers
335---------------------------
336
337Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
338the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
339details.
340
341
3422. Configuring HAProxy
343----------------------
344
3452.1. Configuration file format
346------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200347
348HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
349
350 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
351 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
352 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
353 "frontend" and "backend".
354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100355The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
356referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
357delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100358preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100359escaped by doubling them.
360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
3622.2. Time format
363----------------
364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100365Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100366values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
367otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
368numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
369for every keyword. Supported units are :
370
371 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
372 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
373 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
374 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
375 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
376 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
377
378
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003792.3. Examples
380-------------
381
382 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
383 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
384 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
385 global
386 daemon
387 maxconn 256
388
389 defaults
390 mode http
391 timeout connect 5000ms
392 timeout client 50000ms
393 timeout server 50000ms
394
395 frontend http-in
396 bind *:80
397 default_backend servers
398
399 backend servers
400 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
401
402
403 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
404 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
405 global
406 daemon
407 maxconn 256
408
409 defaults
410 mode http
411 timeout connect 5000ms
412 timeout client 50000ms
413 timeout server 50000ms
414
415 listen http-in
416 bind *:80
417 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
418
419
420Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
421
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100422 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200423
424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004253. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200426--------------------
427
428Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
429are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
430of them have command-line equivalents.
431
432The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
433
434 * Process management and security
435 - chroot
436 - daemon
437 - gid
438 - group
439 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100440 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - nbproc
442 - pidfile
443 - uid
444 - ulimit-n
445 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200446 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200447 - node
448 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100449 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100450
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200451 * Performance tuning
452 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200453 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100454 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200455 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - noepoll
457 - nokqueue
458 - nopoll
459 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100460 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200461 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200462 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200463 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200464 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100465 - tune.maxaccept
466 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200467 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200468 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100469 - tune.rcvbuf.client
470 - tune.rcvbuf.server
471 - tune.sndbuf.client
472 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100473
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474 * Debugging
475 - debug
476 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477
478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004793.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200480------------------------------------
481
482chroot <jail dir>
483 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
484 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
485 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
486 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
487 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
488 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100489
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200490daemon
491 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
492 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
493 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
494
495gid <number>
496 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
497 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
498 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
499 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100500
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200501group <group name>
502 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
503 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200505log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
507 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100508 configured with "log global".
509
510 <address> can be one of:
511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100512 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100513 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
514 port).
515
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100516 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
517 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
518 port).
519
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100520 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
521 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
522 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
523 writeable).
524
525 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526
527 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
528 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
529 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
530
531 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200532 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
533 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
534 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
535 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
536 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
537 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200538
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200539 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100541log-send-hostname [<string>]
542 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
543 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
544 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
545 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
546 the logs.
547
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000548log-tag <string>
549 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
550 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
551 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
552 running on the same host.
553
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554nbproc <number>
555 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
556 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
557 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
558 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
559 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
560
561pidfile <pidfile>
562 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
563 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
564 starting the process. See also "daemon".
565
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200566stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200567 [level <level>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200568
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200569 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
570 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100571 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200572 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
573
574 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
575 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
576 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
577 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
578 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
579
580 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200581 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200582 counters).
583
584 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
585 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100586
587 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
588 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
589 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
590 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
591 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
592 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
593 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200594
595stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
596 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
597 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100598 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200599
600stats maxconn <connections>
601 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
602 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
603
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604uid <number>
605 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
606 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
607 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
608 one. See also "gid" and "user".
609
610ulimit-n <number>
611 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
612 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
613 option.
614
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100615unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
616 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
617
618 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
619 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
620 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
621 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
622 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
623 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
624 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
625 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
626 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
627 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
628
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200629user <user name>
630 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
631 See also "uid" and "group".
632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200633node <name>
634 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
635
636 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
637 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
638 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
639 traffic.
640
641description <text>
642 Add a text that describes the instance.
643
644 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
645 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
646 "<" and ">" characters.
647
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006493.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200650-----------------------
651
652maxconn <number>
653 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
654 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
655 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
656 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
657
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200658maxconnrate <number>
659 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
660 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
661 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
662 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
663 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
664 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
665 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
666 fairness.
667
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100668maxpipes <number>
669 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
670 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
671 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
672 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
673 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
674 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
675
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200676maxsslconn <number>
677 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
678 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
679 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
680 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
681 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
682 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
683 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685noepoll
686 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
687 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
688 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
689
690nokqueue
691 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
692 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
693 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
694
695nopoll
696 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
697 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100698 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200699 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
700 "nokqueue".
701
702nosepoll
703 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
704 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
705 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
706
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100707nosplice
708 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
709 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
710 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100711 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100712 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
713 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
714 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
715 "option splice-response".
716
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200717spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
718 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
719 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
720 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
721 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
722 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
723
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200724tune.bufsize <number>
725 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
726 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
727 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
728 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
729 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
730 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
731 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
732 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
733
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200734tune.chksize <number>
735 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
736 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
737 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
738 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
739 checks whenever possible.
740
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200741tune.http.maxhdr <number>
742 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
743 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
744 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
745 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
746 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
747 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
748 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
749 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
750 limit too high.
751
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100752tune.maxaccept <number>
753 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
754 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
755 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100756 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100757 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
758 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100759 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100760 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
761
762tune.maxpollevents <number>
763 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
764 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
765 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
766 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
767 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
768
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200769tune.maxrewrite <number>
770 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
771 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
772 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
773 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
774 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
775 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
776 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
777 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
778 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
779 bufsize.
780
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200781tune.pipesize <number>
782 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
783 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
784 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
785 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
786 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
787 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
788
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100789tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
790tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
791 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
792 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
793 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
794 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
795 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
796 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
797 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
798
799tune.sndbuf.client <number>
800tune.sndbuf.server <number>
801 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
802 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
803 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
804 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
805 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
806 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
807 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
808 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
809 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
810 notifying haproxy again.
811
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008133.3. Debugging
814--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200815
816debug
817 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
818 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
819 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
820 system startup.
821
822quiet
823 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
824 line argument "-q".
825
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008273.4. Userlists
828--------------
829It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
830http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
831it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
832
833userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100834 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100835 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
836
837group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100838 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100839 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
840 proceeded by "users" keyword.
841
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100842user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
843 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100844 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
845 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100846 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
847 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100848 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
849 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
850
851
852 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100853 userlist L1
854 group G1 users tiger,scott
855 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100856
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100857 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
858 user scott insecure-password elgato
859 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100860
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100861 userlist L2
862 group G1
863 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100864
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100865 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
866 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
867 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100868
869 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200870
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200871
8723.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200873----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200874It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
875haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
876pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
877identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
878or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
879Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
880known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
881the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
882process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
883during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
884tables.
885
886peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400887 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200888 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
889
890peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
891 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
892 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
893 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
894 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
895 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
896 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
897
898 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
899 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
900
901 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
902 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
903 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
904 across all peers.
905
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200906 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200907 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100908 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
909 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
910 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200911
912 backend mybackend
913 mode tcp
914 balance roundrobin
915 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
916 stick on src
917
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100918 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
919 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200920
921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009224. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100924
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200925Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
926 - defaults <name>
927 - frontend <name>
928 - backend <name>
929 - listen <name>
930
931A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
932its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
933section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100934section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200935
936A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
937connections.
938
939A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
940to forward incoming connections.
941
942A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
943parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
944
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100945All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
946'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
947case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
948
949Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
950logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
951proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
952However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
953name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
954
955Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
956and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100957bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100958protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
959modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
960arbitrary criteria.
961
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009634.1. Proxy keywords matrix
964--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100965
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200966The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
967limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
968they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
969limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100970marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200971option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200972and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
973with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
974specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100975
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200976
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100977 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
978------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
979acl - X X X
980appsession - - X X
981backlog X X X -
982balance X - X X
983bind - X X -
984bind-process X X X X
985block - X X X
986capture cookie - X X -
987capture request header - X X -
988capture response header - X X -
989clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
990contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
991cookie X - X X
992default-server X - X X
993default_backend X X X -
994description - X X X
995disabled X X X X
996dispatch - - X X
997enabled X X X X
998errorfile X X X X
999errorloc X X X X
1000errorloc302 X X X X
1001-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1002errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001003force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001004fullconn X - X X
1005grace X X X X
1006hash-type X - X X
1007http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001008http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001009http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001010http-request - X X X
1011id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001012ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001013log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001014maxconn X X X -
1015mode X X X X
1016monitor fail - X X -
1017monitor-net X X X -
1018monitor-uri X X X -
1019option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1020option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1021option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1022option allbackups (*) X - X X
1023option checkcache (*) X - X X
1024option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1025option contstats (*) X X X -
1026option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1027option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1028option forceclose (*) X X X X
1029-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1030option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001031option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001032option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001033option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1034option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1035option httpchk X - X X
1036option httpclose (*) X X X X
1037option httplog X X X X
1038option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001039option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001040option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001041option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1042option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1043option logasap (*) X X X -
1044option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001045option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001046option nolinger (*) X X X X
1047option originalto X X X X
1048option persist (*) X - X X
1049option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001050option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001051option smtpchk X - X X
1052option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1053option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1054option splice-request (*) X X X X
1055option splice-response (*) X X X X
1056option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1057option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1058-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1059option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1060option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1061option tcpka X X X X
1062option tcplog X X X X
1063option transparent (*) X - X X
1064persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1065rate-limit sessions X X X -
1066redirect - X X X
1067redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1068redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1069reqadd - X X X
1070reqallow - X X X
1071reqdel - X X X
1072reqdeny - X X X
1073reqiallow - X X X
1074reqidel - X X X
1075reqideny - X X X
1076reqipass - X X X
1077reqirep - X X X
1078reqisetbe - X X X
1079reqitarpit - X X X
1080reqpass - X X X
1081reqrep - X X X
1082-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1083reqsetbe - X X X
1084reqtarpit - X X X
1085retries X - X X
1086rspadd - X X X
1087rspdel - X X X
1088rspdeny - X X X
1089rspidel - X X X
1090rspideny - X X X
1091rspirep - X X X
1092rsprep - X X X
1093server - - X X
1094source X - X X
1095srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001096stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001097stats auth X - X X
1098stats enable X - X X
1099stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001100stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001101stats realm X - X X
1102stats refresh X - X X
1103stats scope X - X X
1104stats show-desc X - X X
1105stats show-legends X - X X
1106stats show-node X - X X
1107stats uri X - X X
1108-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1109stick match - - X X
1110stick on - - X X
1111stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001112stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001113stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001114tcp-request connection - X X -
1115tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001116tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001117tcp-response content - - X X
1118tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001119timeout check X - X X
1120timeout client X X X -
1121timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1122timeout connect X - X X
1123timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1124timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1125timeout http-request X X X X
1126timeout queue X - X X
1127timeout server X - X X
1128timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1129timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001130timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001131transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001132unique-id-format X X X -
1133unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001134use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001135use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001136------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1137 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011404.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1141---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001142
1143This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1144
1145
1146acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1147 Declare or complete an access list.
1148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1149 no | yes | yes | yes
1150 Example:
1151 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1152 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1153 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001155 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001156
1157
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001158appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1159 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001160 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1162 no | no | yes | yes
1163 Arguments :
1164 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1165 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1166
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001167 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001168 checked in each cookie value.
1169
1170 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1171 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1172 milliseconds.
1173
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001174 request-learn
1175 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1176 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1177 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1178 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1179 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1180 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1181
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001182 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1183 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1184 data following this prefix.
1185
1186 Example :
1187 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1188
1189 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1190 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1191
1192 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1193 2 modes are currently supported :
1194 - path-parameters :
1195 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1196 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1197 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1198 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1199 - query-string :
1200 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1201 query string.
1202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001203 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1204 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1205 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1206 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001207 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1208 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1209 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001210 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1211 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1212
1213 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1214
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001215 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1216 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1217 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1218
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001219 Example :
1220 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1221
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001222 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1223 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001224
1225
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001226backlog <conns>
1227 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1229 yes | yes | yes | no
1230 Arguments :
1231 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1232 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001233 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001234
1235 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1236 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1237 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1238 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1239 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1240 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1241 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1242 backlog parameter.
1243
1244 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1245 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1246 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1247
1248 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1249
1250
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001251balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001252balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001253 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1255 yes | no | yes | yes
1256 Arguments :
1257 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1258 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1259 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1260 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1261
1262 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1263 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1264 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1265 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001266 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1267 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1268 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1269 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1270 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1271 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1272 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1273 it, so that you don't worry.
1274
1275 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1276 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1277 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1278 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1279 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1280 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1281 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1282 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001283
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001284 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1285 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1286 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1287 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1288 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1289 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1290 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1291 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1292
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001293 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1294 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1295 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1296 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001297 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001298 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1299 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1300 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1301 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1302 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001303 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1304 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1305 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1306 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1307 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1308 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001309
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001310 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1311 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1312 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1313 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1314 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1315 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1316 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1317 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001318 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001319 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001320 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1321 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1322 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001323
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001324 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1325 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1326 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1327 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1328 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1329 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1330 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1331 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1332 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1333 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1334 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1335 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001336
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001337 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001338 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1339 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1340 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1341 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1342 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1343 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1344 URIs start with a leading "/".
1345
1346 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1347 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1348 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1349 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1350
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001351 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001352 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1353
1354 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001355 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1356 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1357 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1358 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1359 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1360 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1361 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1362 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1363 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1364 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1365 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1366 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1367 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1368 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1369 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1370 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1371 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1372 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1373 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001374
1375 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1376 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1377 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1378 server will receive the request.
1379
1380 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1381 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1382 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1383 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1384 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001385 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1386 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1387 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001388
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001389 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1390 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1391 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1392 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1393 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001395 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001396 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1397 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1398 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1399
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001400 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1401 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1402 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1403
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001404 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001405 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001406 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1407 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1408 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1409 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1410 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1411 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001412 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001413 used instead.
1414
1415 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1416 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1417 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1418 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1419
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001420 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1421 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1422 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1423
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001424 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001426 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001427 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1428 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001429
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001430 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001431 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001432
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001433 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1434 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1435 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001436
1437 Examples :
1438 balance roundrobin
1439 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001440 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001441 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1442 balance hdr(host)
1443 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001444
1445 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1446 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001448 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001449 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1450 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1451 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1452 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1453
1454 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1455 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1456 defaults to 16 kB.
1457
1458 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1459 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1460
1461 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1462 Round Robin.
1463
1464 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1465 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1466 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1467 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1468
1469 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1470
1471 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001472 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001473 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1474 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1475 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001476
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001477 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1478 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479
1480
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001481bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1482bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1483bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
Willy Tarreau32368ce2012-09-06 11:10:55 +02001484bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] backlog <backlog>
1485bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreau50acaaa2012-09-06 14:26:36 +02001486bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] nice <nice>
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001487bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1488bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1489bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1490bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001491bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] ssl
1492bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] crt <cert>
1493bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] ciphers <ciphers>
1494bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] nosslv3
1495bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] notlsv1
1496bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] prefer-server-ciphers
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001497bind /<path> [, ...]
1498bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1499bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1500bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001501 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1503 no | yes | yes | no
1504 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001505 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1506 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1507 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1508 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001509 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001510
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001511 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1512 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001513 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1514 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1515 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001516 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1517 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1518 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1519 the range.
1520
1521 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1522 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1523 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1524 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1525 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1526 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1527 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001528 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001529 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001530
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001531 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1532 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1533 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1534 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1535 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1536 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1537 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1538 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1539
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001540 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1541 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1542 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1543 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1544 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1545 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1546 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1547 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001548 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1549 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001550
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001551 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1552 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1553 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1554 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001555 kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux
1556 but was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may
1557 not work on other operating systems. It may also not change
1558 the advertised value but change the effective size of
1559 outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet
1560 networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
1561 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is
1562 negative, it will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming
1563 connection's advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This
1564 parameter is only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001565
Willy Tarreau32368ce2012-09-06 11:10:55 +02001566 <backlog> sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the
1567 frontend's backlog is used instead.
1568
1569 <maxconn> limits the socket to this number of concurrent connections.
1570 Extra connections will remain in the system's backlog until a
1571 connection is released. If unspecified, the limit will be the
1572 same as the frontend's maxconn. Note that in case of port
1573 ranges, the same value will be applied to each socket. This
1574 setting enables different limitations on expensive sockets,
1575 for instance SSL entries which may easily eat all memory.
1576
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001577 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1578 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1579 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1580 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001581
Willy Tarreau50acaaa2012-09-06 14:26:36 +02001582 <nice> sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket.
1583 Value must be in the range -1024..1024, and default is zero.
1584 Positive values means that such connections are more friendly
1585 to others and easily offer their place in the scheduler. On
1586 the opposite, negative values mean that connections want to
1587 run with a higher priority. The difference only happens under
1588 high loads when the system is close to saturation. Negative
1589 values are appropriate for low-latency or admin services, and
1590 high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks
1591 such as SSL processing which are less sensible to latency.
1592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001593 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1594
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001595 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1596 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1597 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1598 simply ignore this.
1599
1600 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1601 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1602 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1603 simply ignore this.
1604
1605 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1606 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1607 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1608 this.
1609
1610 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1611 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1612 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1613 this.
1614
1615 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1616 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1617 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1618 this.
1619
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001620 <cert> designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate
1621 and the assocaited private key. This file can be build by
1622 concatenating both PEM files into one. If a directory name is
1623 used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in that
1624 directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified
1625 multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple
1626 files or directories. The certificates will be presented to
1627 clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field
1628 matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
1629 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of
1630 the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
1631 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is
1632 provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
1633 TLS extensions, or if the client provides and SNI which does
1634 not match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate
1635 will be presented. This means that when loading certificates
1636 from a directory, it is highly recommended to load the
1637 default one first as a file. Note that the same cert may be
1638 loaded multiple times without side effects.
1639
1640 <ciphers> is the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that
1641 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the
1642 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers", and can be for instance
1643 "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH".
1644
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001645 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1646 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1647 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001648 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001649 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1650 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1651 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1652 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001653 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1654 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001655
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001656 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001657 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1658 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1659 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1660 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1661 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1662 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1663 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1664 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1665 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1666 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1667 with front firewalls which would see an established
1668 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1669
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001670 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1671 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1672 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1673 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1674 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1675 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1676 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1677 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1678 This keyword combined with support from external components
1679 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1680 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1681 not even always usable.
1682
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001683 ssl enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this
1684 listener. A certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All
1685 contents in the buffers will be in clear text, so that ACLs
1686 and HTTP processing will only have access to deciphered
1687 contents.
1688
1689 nosslv3 disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is supported. Note that
1690 SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled using any
1691 configuration option.
1692
1693 notlsv1 disables support for TLSv1 when SSL is supported. Note that
1694 SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled using any
1695 configuration option.
1696
1697 prefer-server-ciphers
1698 tells the SSL/TLS layer that our set of cipher algorithms is
1699 preferred over the client's ones.
1700
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001701 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1702 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1703 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1704 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1705 in a frontend.
1706
1707 Example :
1708 listen http_proxy
1709 bind :80,:443
1710 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001711 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001712
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001713 listen http_https_proxy
1714 bind :80
1715 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem prefer-server-ciphers
1716
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001717 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001718 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719
1720
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001721bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1722 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1724 yes | yes | yes | yes
1725 Arguments :
1726 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1727 may be used to override a default value.
1728
1729 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1730 option may be combined with other numbers.
1731
1732 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1733 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1734 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1735 missing from all processes.
1736
1737 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1738 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1739 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1740 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1741
1742 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1743 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1744 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1745 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1746 and 'even' instances.
1747
1748 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1749 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1750 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1751 32.
1752
1753 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1754 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1755
1756 Example :
1757 listen app_ip1
1758 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001759 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001760
1761 listen app_ip2
1762 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001763 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001764
1765 listen management
1766 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001767 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001768
1769 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1770
1771
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001772block { if | unless } <condition>
1773 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1775 no | yes | yes | yes
1776
1777 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1778 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001779 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001780 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1782 "block" statements per instance.
1783
1784 Example:
1785 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1786 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1787 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1788 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001790 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001791
1792
1793capture cookie <name> len <length>
1794 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1796 no | yes | yes | no
1797 Arguments :
1798 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1799 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1800 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1801 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1802 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1803
1804 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1805 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1806 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1807 right if it exceeds <length>.
1808
1809 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1810 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1811 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1812 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1813
1814 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1815 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1816 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1817
1818 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1819 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1820 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1821 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001822 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001823 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1824
1825 Example:
1826 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1827
1828 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001829 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001830
1831
1832capture request header <name> len <length>
1833 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1835 no | yes | yes | no
1836 Arguments :
1837 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001838 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001839 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1840 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1841 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1842
1843 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1844 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1845 it exceeds <length>.
1846
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001847 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1849 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001850 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1851 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1852 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1853 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001854 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001855 environments to find where the request came from.
1856
1857 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1858 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1859 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1860 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001861
1862 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1863 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1864 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1865 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1866
1867 Example:
1868 capture request header Host len 15
1869 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1870 capture request header Referrer len 15
1871
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001872 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873 about logging.
1874
1875
1876capture response header <name> len <length>
1877 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1879 no | yes | yes | no
1880 Arguments :
1881 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001882 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1884 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1885 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1886
1887 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1888 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1889 it exceeds <length>.
1890
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001891 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1893 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1894 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001895 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1896 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1897 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1898 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001899
1900 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1901 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1902 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1903 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1904
1905 Example:
1906 capture response header Content-length len 9
1907 capture response header Location len 15
1908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001909 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001910 about logging.
1911
1912
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001913clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001914 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1916 yes | yes | yes | no
1917 Arguments :
1918 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1919 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1920 as explained at the top of this document.
1921
1922 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1923 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1924 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1925 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1926 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1927 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1928 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1929 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001930 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001931 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1932 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1933
1934 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1935 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1936 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1937 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1938 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1939 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1940
1941 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1942 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1943
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001944 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1945 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001946
1947
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001948contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001949 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1951 yes | no | yes | yes
1952 Arguments :
1953 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1954 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1955 as explained at the top of this document.
1956
1957 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001958 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001959 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001960 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1961 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1962 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1963 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1964
1965 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1966 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1967 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1968 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1969 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1970 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1971
1972 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1973 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1974 instead.
1975
1976 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1977 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1978
1979
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001980cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001981 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1982 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001983 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1985 yes | no | yes | yes
1986 Arguments :
1987 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1988 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1989 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1990 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1991 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1992 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1993 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1994 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1995 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1996
1997 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1998 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1999 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2000 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2001 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2002 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2003 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2004 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2005 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2006 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2007 "insert" and "prefix".
2008
2009 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002010 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002011
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002012 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002013 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2014 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2015 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2016 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2017 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2018 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2019 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2020 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2021 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2022 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023
2024 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2025 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2026 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2027 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2028 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2029 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2030 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2031 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2032 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2033 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002034 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2035 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2036 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002037
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002038 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2039 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2040 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002041 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2042 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2043 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2044 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002045 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2046 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2047 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002048
2049 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2050 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2051 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2052 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2053 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2054 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2055 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2056 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2057 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2058
2059 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2060 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2061 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2062 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2063 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2064 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2065 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2066 persistence cookie in the cache.
2067 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2068
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002069 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2070 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2071 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2072 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2073 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2074 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2075 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2076 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2077 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2078 they logout.
2079
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002080 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2081 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2082 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2083 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2084
2085 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2086 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2087 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2088 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2089 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2090 this attribute.
2091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002092 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002093 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002094 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2095 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2096 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2097 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2098 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2099 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002100
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002101 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2102 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2103 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2104 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2105 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2106 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2107 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2108 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2109 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2110 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2111 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2112 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2113 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2114 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2115 the site.
2116
2117 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2118 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2119 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2120 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2121 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2122 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2123 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2124 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2125 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2126 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2127 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2128 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2129 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2130 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2131 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2132 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2133
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2135 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2136 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2137 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002138
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002139 Examples :
2140 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2141 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2142 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002143 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002144
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002145 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002146 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002148
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002149default-server [param*]
2150 Change default options for a server in a backend
2151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2152 yes | no | yes | yes
2153 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002154 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2155 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2156 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2157 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002158
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002159 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002160 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2161
2162 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002163
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002164
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002165default_backend <backend>
2166 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2168 yes | yes | yes | no
2169 Arguments :
2170 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2171
2172 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2173 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2174 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2175 will catch all undetermined requests.
2176
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002177 Example :
2178
2179 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2180 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2181 default_backend dynamic
2182
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002183 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2184
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002185
2186disabled
2187 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2189 yes | yes | yes | yes
2190 Arguments : none
2191
2192 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2193 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2194 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2195 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2196 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2197 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2198 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2199
2200 See also : "enabled"
2201
2202
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002203dispatch <address>:<port>
2204 Set a default server address
2205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2206 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002207 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002208
2209 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2210 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2211 during start-up.
2212
2213 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2214 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2215 possible with normal servers.
2216
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002217 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002218 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2219 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2220 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2221 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2222
2223 See also : "server"
2224
2225
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002226enabled
2227 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2229 yes | yes | yes | yes
2230 Arguments : none
2231
2232 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2233 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2234
2235 See also : "disabled"
2236
2237
2238errorfile <code> <file>
2239 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2241 yes | yes | yes | yes
2242 Arguments :
2243 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002244 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
2246 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002247 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002248 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002249 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2250 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002251
2252 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2253 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2254 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2255
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002256 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2257
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002258 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2259 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2260 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2261 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2262
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002263 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2264 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2265 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2266 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2267 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2268 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002270 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2271 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2272 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002273 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2275
2276 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2277
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002278 Example :
2279 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2280 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2281 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2282
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002283
2284errorloc <code> <url>
2285errorloc302 <code> <url>
2286 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2288 yes | yes | yes | yes
2289 Arguments :
2290 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002291 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002292
2293 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2294 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2295 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2296 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2297 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2298
2299 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2300 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2301 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2302
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002303 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2304
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002305 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2306 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2307 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2308 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2309 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2310 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2311 request.
2312
2313 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2314
2315
2316errorloc303 <code> <url>
2317 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2319 yes | yes | yes | yes
2320 Arguments :
2321 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2322 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2323
2324 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2325 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2326 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2327 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2328 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2329
2330 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2331 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2332 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2333
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002334 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2335
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002336 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2337 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2338 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2339 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002340 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002341
2342 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2343
2344
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002345force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2346 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2347 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2348 no | yes | yes | yes
2349
2350 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2351 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2352 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2353 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2354 marked down for maintenance operations.
2355
2356 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2357 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2358 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2359 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2360 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2361 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2362 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2363 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2364 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2365
2366 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2367 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2368 is used.
2369
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002370 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002371 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002372
2373
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002374fullconn <conns>
2375 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2377 yes | no | yes | yes
2378 Arguments :
2379 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2380 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2381
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002382 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002383 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002384 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002385 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2386 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2387 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2388 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2389 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002390 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002391
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002392 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2393 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2394 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2395
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002396 Example :
2397 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2398 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2399 # connections.
2400 backend dynamic
2401 fullconn 10000
2402 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2403 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2404
2405 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2406
2407
2408grace <time>
2409 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002411 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002412 Arguments :
2413 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2414 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2415 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2416
2417 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2418 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002419 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002420 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2421
2422 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2423 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2424 simplify it.
2425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002426
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002427hash-type <method>
2428 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2430 yes | no | yes | yes
2431 Arguments :
2432 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2433 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2434 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2435 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2436 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2437 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2438 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2439 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2440 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2441
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002442 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2443 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2444 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2445 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2446 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2447 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2448 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2449 this value.
2450
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002451 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2452 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2453 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2454 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2455 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2456 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2457 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2458 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2459 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2460 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2461 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2462 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2463 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2464
2465 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2466
2467 See also : "balance", "server"
2468
2469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002470http-check disable-on-404
2471 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002473 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002474 Arguments : none
2475
2476 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2477 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2478 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2479 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2480 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2481 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2482 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2483 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002484 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2485 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2486 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2487
2488 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2489
2490
2491http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002492 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002494 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002495 Arguments :
2496 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2497 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002498 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002499 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2500 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2501 details on the supported keywords.
2502
2503 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2504 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2505 with the usual backslash ('\').
2506
2507 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2508 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2509 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2510 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2511 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2512
2513 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002514 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002515 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2516 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2517 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2518
2519 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002520 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002521 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2522 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2523 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2524 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2525
2526 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002527 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002528 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2529 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2530 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2531 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2532 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2533 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2534 trace).
2535
2536 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002537 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002538 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2539 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2540 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2541 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2542 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2543 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2544
2545 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2546 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2547 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2548 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2549 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2550 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2551 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2552 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2553
2554 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2555 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2556
2557 Examples :
2558 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002559 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002560
2561 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002562 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002563
2564 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002565 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002566
2567 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002568 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002570 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002571
2572
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002573http-check send-state
2574 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2576 yes | no | yes | yes
2577 Arguments : none
2578
2579 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2580 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2581 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2582 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2583 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2584
2585 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2586 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2587 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2588 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2589 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2590 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2591 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2592 checked in multiple backends.
2593
2594 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2595 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2596
2597 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2598 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2599 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2600 one fails.
2601
2602 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2603 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2604 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2605
2606 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2607 server's queue.
2608
2609 Example of a header received by the application server :
2610 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2611 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2612
2613 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2614
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002615http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002616 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002617 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2618
2619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2620 no | yes | yes | yes
2621
2622 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2623 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2624 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002625 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2626 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002627 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2628
2629 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2630 instance.
2631
2632 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002633 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2634 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2635 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002636
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002637 http-request allow if nagios
2638 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2639 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2640 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002641
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002642 Example:
2643 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002644
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002645 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002646
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002647 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2648 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002649
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002650http-send-name-header [<header>]
2651 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2652
2653 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2654 yes | no | yes | yes
2655
2656 Arguments :
2657
2658 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2659
2660 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2661 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2662 is added with the header string proved.
2663
2664 See also : "server"
2665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002666id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002667 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2669 no | yes | yes | yes
2670 Arguments : none
2671
2672 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2673 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2674 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002675
2676
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002677ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2678 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2679 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2680 no | yes | yes | yes
2681
2682 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2683 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2684 and running).
2685
2686 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2687 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2688 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2689 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2690 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2691
2692 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2693 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2694
2695 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2696 "unless" condition is met.
2697
2698 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2699
2700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002701log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002702log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002703no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002704 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2706 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002707
2708 Prefix :
2709 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2710 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2711 prefix does not allow arguments.
2712
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002713 Arguments :
2714 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2715 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2716 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2717 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2718 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2719 parameter.
2720
2721 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2722 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2723
2724 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2725 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2726 standard syslog port).
2727
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002728 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2729 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2730 standard syslog port).
2731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002732 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2733 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2734 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2735 appropriately writeable).
2736
2737 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2738
2739 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2740 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2741 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2742
2743 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2744 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2745 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002746 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2747 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2748 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2749 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2750 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002751
2752 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2753
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002754 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2755 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2756 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002757
2758 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2759 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2760 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2761 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2762
2763 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2764 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002765
2766 Example :
2767 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002768 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2769 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002770
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002771log-format <string>
2772 Allows you to custom a log line.
2773
2774 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2775
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002776
2777maxconn <conns>
2778 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2780 yes | yes | yes | no
2781 Arguments :
2782 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2783 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2784 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2785 closes.
2786
2787 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2788 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2789 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2790 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2791 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2792 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2793 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2794 properly tuned.
2795
2796 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2797 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2798 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2799
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002800 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2801
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002802 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2803
2804
2805mode { tcp|http|health }
2806 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2808 yes | yes | yes | yes
2809 Arguments :
2810 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2811 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2812 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2813 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2814
2815 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2816 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2817 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2818 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2819 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2820
2821 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2822 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2823 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2824 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2825 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2826 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2827
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002828 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2829 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2830 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002831
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002832 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002833 defaults http_instances
2834 mode http
2835
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002836 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002837
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002838
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002839monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002840 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2842 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002843 Arguments :
2844 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2845 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002846 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002847 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2848 backend and its backup.
2849
2850 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2851 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2852 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2853 servers in a list of backends.
2854
2855 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2856 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2857 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2858 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2859 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2860 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2861 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002862 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2863 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864
2865 Example:
2866 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002867 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002868 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2869 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2870 monitor-uri /site_alive
2871 monitor fail if site_dead
2872
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002873 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002874
2875
2876monitor-net <source>
2877 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2879 yes | yes | yes | no
2880 Arguments :
2881 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2882 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2883 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2884 followed by a mask.
2885
2886 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2887 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002888 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002889 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2890
2891 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2892 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2893 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2894 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2895 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2896
2897 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2898 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2899 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2900 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2901 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2902
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002903 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2904 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002905
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002906 Example :
2907 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2908 frontend www
2909 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2910
2911 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2912
2913
2914monitor-uri <uri>
2915 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2917 yes | yes | yes | no
2918 Arguments :
2919 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2920 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2921
2922 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2923 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2924 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2925 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2926 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2927 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2928 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2929 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2930
2931 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2932 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2933 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2934 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2935 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2936 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2937
2938 Example :
2939 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2940 frontend www
2941 mode http
2942 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2943
2944 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2945
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002946
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002947option abortonclose
2948no option abortonclose
2949 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2951 yes | no | yes | yes
2952 Arguments : none
2953
2954 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2955 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2956 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2957 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002958 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002959 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2960 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2961 encountered while delivering the response.
2962
2963 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2964 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2965 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2966 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2967 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2968 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002969 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002970 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002971 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002972 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2973 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2974 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2975
2976 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2977 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2978 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2979 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2980 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2981 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2982 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2983 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002984 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002985
2986 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2987 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2988
2989 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2990
2991
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002992option accept-invalid-http-request
2993no option accept-invalid-http-request
2994 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2996 yes | yes | yes | no
2997 Arguments : none
2998
2999 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3000 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3001 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3002 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3003 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3004 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3005 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3006 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003007 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3008 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3009 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3010 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3011 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3012 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003013
3014 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3015 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3016 been confirmed.
3017
3018 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3019 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003020 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3021 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003022 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3023
3024 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3025 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3026
3027 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3028 stats socket.
3029
3030
3031option accept-invalid-http-response
3032no option accept-invalid-http-response
3033 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3035 yes | no | yes | yes
3036 Arguments : none
3037
3038 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3039 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3040 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3041 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3042 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3043 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3044 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3045 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3046 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3047
3048 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3049 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3050 been confirmed.
3051
3052 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3053 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3054 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3055 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3056
3057 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3058 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3059
3060 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3061 stats socket.
3062
3063
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003064option allbackups
3065no option allbackups
3066 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3068 yes | no | yes | yes
3069 Arguments : none
3070
3071 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3072 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3073 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3074 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3075 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3076 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3077 order between the backup servers anymore.
3078
3079 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3080 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3081
3082 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3083 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3084
3085
3086option checkcache
3087no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003088 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3090 yes | no | yes | yes
3091 Arguments : none
3092
3093 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3094 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003095 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003096 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3097 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003098 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003099
3100 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003101 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003102 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003103 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3104 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003105 to the client are :
3106 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003107 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003108 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003109 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3110 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3111 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3112 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3113 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3114 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3115 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3116 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3117 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3118 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3119 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3120
3121 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003122 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003123 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003124 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003125 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3126
3127 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3128 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003129 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003130 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3131
3132 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3133 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3134
3135
3136option clitcpka
3137no option clitcpka
3138 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3140 yes | yes | yes | no
3141 Arguments : none
3142
3143 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3144 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3145 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3146 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3147
3148 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3149 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3150 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3151 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3152
3153 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3154 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3155 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3156 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3157 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3158
3159 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3160
3161 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3162 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3163 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3164
3165 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3166 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3167
3168 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3169
3170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003171option contstats
3172 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3174 yes | yes | yes | no
3175 Arguments : none
3176
3177 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3178 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3179 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3180 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3181 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3182 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3183 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3184
3185
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003186option dontlog-normal
3187no option dontlog-normal
3188 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3190 yes | yes | yes | no
3191 Arguments : none
3192
3193 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3194 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3195 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3196 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3197 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3198 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3199 logged.
3200
3201 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3202 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3203 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003205 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003206 logging.
3207
3208
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003209option dontlognull
3210no option dontlognull
3211 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3213 yes | yes | yes | no
3214 Arguments : none
3215
3216 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3217 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3218 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3219 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3220 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3221 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3222 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3223
3224 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3225 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3226 would not be logged.
3227
3228 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3229 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003231 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003232
3233
3234option forceclose
3235no option forceclose
3236 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003238 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003239 Arguments : none
3240
3241 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3242 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3243 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3244 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3245 global session times in the logs.
3246
3247 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003248 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003249 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3250 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3251 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3252 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003253
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003254 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3255 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3256 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3257
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003258 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3259 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3260
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003261 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003262
3263
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003264option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003265 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3267 yes | yes | yes | yes
3268 Arguments :
3269 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3270 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003271 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003272 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003273
3274 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3275 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3276 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3277 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3278 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3279 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3280 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003281 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3282 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3283 possible that the client has already brought one.
3284
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003285 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003286 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003287 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3288 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003289 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3290 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003291
3292 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3293 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3294 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3295 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3296 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3297 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3298 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3299
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003300 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3301 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3302 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3303 are under the control of the end-user.
3304
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003305 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003306 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3307 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003308 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3309 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3310 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003311
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003312 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3313 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3314 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3315 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3316 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003317
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003318 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003319 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3320 frontend www
3321 mode http
3322 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3323
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003324 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3325 backend www
3326 mode http
3327 option forwardfor header X-Client
3328
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003329 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3330 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003331
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003332
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003333option http-no-delay
3334no option http-no-delay
3335 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3337 yes | yes | yes | yes
3338 Arguments : none
3339
3340 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3341 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3342 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3343 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3344 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3345 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3346 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3347 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3348 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3349 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3350 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3351 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3352 affected.
3353
3354 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3355 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3356 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3357 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3358 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3359 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3360 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3361 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3362 latency environments.
3363
3364
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003365option http-pretend-keepalive
3366no option http-pretend-keepalive
3367 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3369 yes | yes | yes | yes
3370 Arguments : none
3371
3372 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3373 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3374 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3375 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3376 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3377 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3378 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3379 consider the response complete.
3380
3381 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3382 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3383 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3384 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3385 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3386 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3387
3388 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3389 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3390 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3391 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3392 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3393 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3394 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3395
3396 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3397 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003398 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003399 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3400 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003401
3402 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3403 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3404
3405 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3406
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003407
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003408option http-server-close
3409no option http-server-close
3410 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3412 yes | yes | yes | yes
3413 Arguments : none
3414
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003415 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3416 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3417 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3418 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3419 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3420 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3421 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3422 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3423 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3424 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3425 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3426 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003427
3428 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3429 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3430 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3431 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003432 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3433 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003434
3435 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3436 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003437 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3438 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3439 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003440
3441 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3442 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3443
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003444 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3445 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003446
3447
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003448option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003449no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003450 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3452 yes | yes | yes | no
3453 Arguments : none
3454
3455 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3456 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3457 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3458 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3459 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3460 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3461 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3462
3463 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3464 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3465 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3466 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3467 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3468 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3469 request along its whole life.
3470
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003471 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3472 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3473 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3474 front of an existing proxy.
3475
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003476 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3477
3478 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3479 http-server-close".
3480
3481
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003482option httpchk
3483option httpchk <uri>
3484option httpchk <method> <uri>
3485option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3486 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3488 yes | no | yes | yes
3489 Arguments :
3490 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3491 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3492 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3493 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3494 ones.
3495
3496 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3497 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3498 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3499
3500 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3501 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3502 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3503 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3504 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3505
3506 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3507 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3508 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3509 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3510 the lack of any response.
3511
3512 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3513
3514 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3515 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3516 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3517
3518 Examples :
3519 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3520 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3521 backend https_relay
3522 mode tcp
3523 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3524 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3525
3526 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003527 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3528 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003529
3530
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003531option httpclose
3532no option httpclose
3533 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 yes | yes | yes | yes
3536 Arguments : none
3537
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003538 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3539 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3540 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3541 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3542 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3543 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3544 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003545
3546 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003547 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003548 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3549 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3550 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3551 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3552 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003553
3554 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3555 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3556 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003557 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3558 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003559
3560 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3561 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3562
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003563 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3564 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003565
3566
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003567option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003568 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3570 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003571 Arguments :
3572 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3573 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3574 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3575 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3576 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003577
3578 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3579 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3580 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3581 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3582 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3583 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3584 ports.
3585
3586 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3587
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003588 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3589 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3590 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3591 by default.
3592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003593 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003594
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003595
3596option http_proxy
3597no option http_proxy
3598 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3600 yes | yes | yes | yes
3601 Arguments : none
3602
3603 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3604 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3605 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3606 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3607 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3608
3609 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3610 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3611 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3612 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003613 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003614 be analyzed.
3615
3616 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3617 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3618
3619 Example :
3620 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3621 backend direct_forward
3622 option httpclose
3623 option http_proxy
3624
3625 See also : "option httpclose"
3626
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003627
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003628option independent-streams
3629no option independent-streams
3630 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3632 yes | yes | yes | yes
3633 Arguments : none
3634
3635 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3636 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3637 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3638 receive data or not.
3639
3640 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3641 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3642 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3643 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3644 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3645 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3646 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3647 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3648 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3649 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3650 socket buffers.
3651
3652 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3653 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3654 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3655 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3656 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3657
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003658 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3659 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3660 deprecated.
3661
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003662 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003663
3664
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003665option ldap-check
3666 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 yes | no | yes | yes
3669 Arguments : none
3670
3671 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3672 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3673 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3674 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3675
3676 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3677 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3678
3679 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3680 configure it.
3681
3682 Example :
3683 option ldap-check
3684
3685 See also : "option httpchk"
3686
3687
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003688option log-health-checks
3689no option log-health-checks
3690 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3692 yes | no | yes | yes
3693 Arguments : none
3694
3695 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3696 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3697 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3698 of additional information is limited.
3699
3700 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3701 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3702
3703 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3704
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003705
3706option log-separate-errors
3707no option log-separate-errors
3708 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3710 yes | yes | yes | no
3711 Arguments : none
3712
3713 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3714 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3715 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3716 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3717 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3718 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3719 provides very important information.
3720
3721 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3722 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3723 error logs.
3724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003725 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003726 logging.
3727
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003728
3729option logasap
3730no option logasap
3731 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3733 yes | yes | yes | no
3734 Arguments : none
3735
3736 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3737 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3738 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3739 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3740 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3741 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3742 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003743 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003744 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3745 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3746
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003747 Examples :
3748 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3749 mode http
3750 option httplog
3751 option logasap
3752 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3753
3754 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3755 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3756 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3757 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003759 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003760 logging.
3761
3762
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003763option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3764 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3766 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003767 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003768 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3769 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003770
3771 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3772 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3773 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3774 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3775 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3776 in the MySQL table, like this :
3777
3778 USE mysql;
3779 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3780 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3781
3782 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3783 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3784 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3785 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3786 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3787 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3788 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3789 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3790 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3791
3792 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3793 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003794
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003795 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003796
3797 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3798 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3799 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3800 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3801 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3802 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3803
3804 See also: "option httpchk"
3805
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003806option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3807 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3809 yes | no | yes | yes
3810 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003811 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3812 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003813
3814 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3815 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3816 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3817 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3818
3819 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003820
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003821option nolinger
3822no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003823 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003824 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3825 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003826 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003827
3828 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3829 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3830 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3831 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3832 connections.
3833
3834 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3835 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3836 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3837 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3838 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3839 this too.
3840
3841 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3842 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3843 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3844
3845 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3846 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3847 for servers.
3848
3849 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3850 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3851
3852
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003853option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3854 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3856 yes | yes | yes | yes
3857 Arguments :
3858 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3859 matching <network>
3860 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3861 header name.
3862
3863 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3864 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3865 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3866 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3867 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3868 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3869 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3870 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3871 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3872 possible that the client has already brought one.
3873
3874 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3875 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3876 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3877 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3878 header and requires different one.
3879
3880 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3881 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3882 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3883 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3884 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3885 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3886 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3887
3888 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3889 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3890 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3891 both are defined.
3892
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003893 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3894 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3895 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3896 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3897 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003898
3899 Examples :
3900 # Original Destination address
3901 frontend www
3902 mode http
3903 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3904
3905 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3906 backend www
3907 mode http
3908 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3909
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003910 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3911 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003912
3913
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003914option persist
3915no option persist
3916 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3917 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3918 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003919 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003920
3921 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3922 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3923 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3924 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3925 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3926 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3927 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3928 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3929 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3930 redirected to another valid server.
3931
3932 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3933 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3934
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003935 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003936
3937
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003938option redispatch
3939no option redispatch
3940 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3941 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3942 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003943 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003944
3945 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3946 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3947 be able to access the service anymore.
3948
3949 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3950 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3951
3952 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3953 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3954 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003956 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3957 "redisp" keywords.
3958
3959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3961
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003962 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003963
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003964
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003965option redis-check
3966 Use redis health checks for server testing
3967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3968 yes | no | yes | yes
3969 Arguments : none
3970
3971 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3972 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3973 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3974 find the "+PONG" response message.
3975
3976 Example :
3977 option redis-check
3978
3979 See also : "option httpchk"
3980
3981
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003982option smtpchk
3983option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3984 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3986 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003987 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003988 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3989 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3990 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3991
3992 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3993 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3994 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3995
3996 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3997 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3998 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3999 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4000 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4001 dead server.
4002
4003 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4004 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4005 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4006 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4007
4008 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4009 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4010 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4011 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4012 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4013
4014 Example :
4015 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4016
4017 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004020option socket-stats
4021no option socket-stats
4022
4023 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | yes | yes | no
4026
4027 Arguments : none
4028
4029
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004030option splice-auto
4031no option splice-auto
4032 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4034 yes | yes | yes | yes
4035 Arguments : none
4036
4037 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4038 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4039 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4040 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004041 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004042 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4043 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4044 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4045 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4046
4047 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4048 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4049 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4050 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4051 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4052 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4053 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4054 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4055 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4056 keyword.
4057
4058 Example :
4059 option splice-auto
4060
4061 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4062 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4063
4064 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4065 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4066
4067
4068option splice-request
4069no option splice-request
4070 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4072 yes | yes | yes | yes
4073 Arguments : none
4074
4075 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004076 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004077 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4078 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4079 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4080 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4081
4082 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4083
4084 Example :
4085 option splice-request
4086
4087 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4088 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4089
4090 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4091 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4092
4093
4094option splice-response
4095no option splice-response
4096 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4098 yes | yes | yes | yes
4099 Arguments : none
4100
4101 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004102 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004103 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4104 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4105 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4106 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4107
4108 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4109
4110 Example :
4111 option splice-response
4112
4113 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4114 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4115
4116 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4117 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4118
4119
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004120option srvtcpka
4121no option srvtcpka
4122 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4124 yes | no | yes | yes
4125 Arguments : none
4126
4127 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4128 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4129 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4130 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4131
4132 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4133 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4134 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4135 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4136
4137 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4138 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4139 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4140 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4141 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4142
4143 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4144
4145 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4146 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4147 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4148
4149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4151
4152 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4153
4154
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004155option ssl-hello-chk
4156 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4158 yes | no | yes | yes
4159 Arguments : none
4160
4161 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4162 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4163 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4164 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4165 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4166 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4167 hello message.
4168
4169 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4170 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4171 messages, which is appreciable.
4172
4173 See also: "option httpchk"
4174
4175
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004176option tcp-smart-accept
4177no option tcp-smart-accept
4178 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4180 yes | yes | yes | no
4181 Arguments : none
4182
4183 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4184 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4185 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4186 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4187 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4188 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4189
4190 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4191 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4192 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4193 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4194
4195 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4196 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4197 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4198 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4199
4200 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4201 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4202 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4203
4204 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4205 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4206 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4207
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004208 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4209
4210
4211option tcp-smart-connect
4212no option tcp-smart-connect
4213 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4215 yes | no | yes | yes
4216 Arguments : none
4217
4218 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4219 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4220 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4221 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4222 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4223
4224 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4225 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4226 complex.
4227
4228 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4229 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4230 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4231
4232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4234
4235 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4236
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004237
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004238option tcpka
4239 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4241 yes | yes | yes | yes
4242 Arguments : none
4243
4244 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4245 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4246 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4247 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4248
4249 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4250 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4251 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4252 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4253
4254 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4255 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4256 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4257 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4258 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4259
4260 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4261
4262 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4263 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4264 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4265 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4266 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4267 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4268 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4269 backends.
4270
4271 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4272
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004273
4274option tcplog
4275 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4277 yes | yes | yes | yes
4278 Arguments : none
4279
4280 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4281 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4282 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4283 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4284 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4285 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4286 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4287 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4288
4289 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004291 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004292
4293
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004294option transparent
4295no option transparent
4296 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004298 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004299 Arguments : none
4300
4301 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4302 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4303 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4304 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4305 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4306 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4307 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4308 appropriate server.
4309
4310 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4311 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4312
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004313 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004314 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004315
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004316
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004317persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004318persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004319 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4321 yes | no | yes | yes
4322 Arguments :
4323 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004324 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4325 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004326
4327 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4328 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4329 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4330 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4331 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4332 forwarded to this server.
4333
4334 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4335 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4336 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004337 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004338 a single "listen" section.
4339
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004340 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4341 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4342 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4343
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004344 Example :
4345 listen tse-farm
4346 bind :3389
4347 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4348 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4349 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4350 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4351 persist rdp-cookie
4352 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004353 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004354 balance rdp-cookie
4355 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4356 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4357
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004358 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4359 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004360
4361
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004362rate-limit sessions <rate>
4363 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4365 yes | yes | yes | no
4366 Arguments :
4367 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4368 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4369
4370 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4371 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4372 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4373 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4374 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4375 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4376
4377 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4378 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4379 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4380 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4381
4382 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4383 listen smtp
4384 mode tcp
4385 bind :25
4386 rate-limit sessions 10
4387 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4388
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004389 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4390 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4391 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004392
4393 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4394
4395
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004396redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4397redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004398 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4400 no | yes | yes | yes
4401
4402 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004403 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004404
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004405 Arguments :
4406 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4407 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4408 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4409 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004410 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4411 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4412 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4413 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004414
4415 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4416 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4417 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4418 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4419 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4420 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4421 location with a GET method.
4422
4423 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4424 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4425
4426 - "drop-query"
4427 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4428 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4429 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4430 with a location-type redirect.
4431
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004432 - "append-slash"
4433 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4434 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4435 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4436 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4437
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004438 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4439 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4440 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4441 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4442 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4443 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4444 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4445
4446 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4447 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4448 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4449 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4450 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4451 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4452 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004453
4454 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4455 acl clear dst_port 80
4456 acl secure dst_port 8080
4457 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004458 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004459 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004460 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4461
4462 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004463 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4464 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4465 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004466 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004467
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004468 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4469 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4470 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004472 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004473
4474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004475redisp (deprecated)
4476redispatch (deprecated)
4477 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4478 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4479 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004480 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004481
4482 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4483 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4484 be able to access the service anymore.
4485
4486 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4487 redistribute them to a working server.
4488
4489 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4490 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4491 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004492
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004493 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4494 "option redispatch" instead.
4495
4496 See also : "option redispatch"
4497
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004498
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004499reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004500 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4502 no | yes | yes | yes
4503 Arguments :
4504 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4505 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004506 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004507
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004508 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4509 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4510
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004511 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4512 the last header of an HTTP request.
4513
4514 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4515 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4516 responses.
4517
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004518 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4519 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4520 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4521
4522 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4523 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004524
4525
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004526reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4527reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004528 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4530 no | yes | yes | yes
4531 Arguments :
4532 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4533 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4534 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4535 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4536 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4537 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4538 ignores case.
4539
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004540 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4541 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4542
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004543 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4544 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4545 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4546 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004547 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004548
4549 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4550 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4551
4552 Example :
4553 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4554 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4555 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4556
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004557 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4558 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004559
4560
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004561reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4562reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004563 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4565 no | yes | yes | yes
4566 Arguments :
4567 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4568 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4569 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4570 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4571 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4572 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4573
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004574 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4575 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4576
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004577 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4578 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4579 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4580 next servers.
4581
4582 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4583 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4584 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4585
4586 Example :
4587 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4588 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4589 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4590
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004591 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4592 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004593
4594
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004595reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4596reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004597 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4599 no | yes | yes | yes
4600 Arguments :
4601 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4602 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4603 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4604 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4605 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4606 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4607 case.
4608
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004609 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4610 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4611
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004612 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4613 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4614 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4615 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004616 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004617
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004618 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004619 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004620 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004621
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004622 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4623 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4624
4625 Example :
4626 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4627 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4628 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4629
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004630 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4631 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004632
4633
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004634reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4635reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004636 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4638 no | yes | yes | yes
4639 Arguments :
4640 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4641 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4642 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4643 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4644 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4645 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4646 case.
4647
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004648 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4649 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4650
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004651 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4652 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4653 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4654 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4655
4656 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4657 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4658
4659 Example :
4660 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4661 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4662 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4663 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4664
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004665 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4666 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004667
4668
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004669reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4670reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004671 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4673 no | yes | yes | yes
4674 Arguments :
4675 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4676 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4677 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4678 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4679 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4680 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4681
4682 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4683 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4684 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4685 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004686 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004687
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004688 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4689 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4690
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004691 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4692 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4693 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4694
4695 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4696 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4697 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4698 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4699 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4700
4701 Example :
4702 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004703 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004704 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4705 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4706
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004707 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4708 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004709
4710
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004711reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4712reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004713 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4715 no | yes | yes | yes
4716 Arguments :
4717 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4718 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4719 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4720 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4721 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4722 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4723 ignores case.
4724
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004725 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4726 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4727
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004728 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4729 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004730 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4731 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4732 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004733 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4734 not set.
4735
4736 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4737 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4738 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4739 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4740 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4741
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004742 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004743 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4744 # block all others.
4745 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4746 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4747
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004748 # block bad guys
4749 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4750 reqitarpit . if badguys
4751
4752 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4753 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004754
4755
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004756retries <value>
4757 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4758 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4759 yes | no | yes | yes
4760 Arguments :
4761 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4762 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4763 default value is 3.
4764
4765 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4766 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4767 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4768
4769 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4770 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4771
4772 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4773 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4774
4775 See also : "option redispatch"
4776
4777
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004778rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004779 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4781 no | yes | yes | yes
4782 Arguments :
4783 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4784 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004785 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004786
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004787 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4788 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4789
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004790 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4791 the last header of an HTTP response.
4792
4793 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4794 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4795 responses.
4796
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004797 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4798 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004799
4800
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004801rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4802rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004803 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4805 no | yes | yes | yes
4806 Arguments :
4807 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4808 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4809 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4810 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4811 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4812 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4813 ignores case.
4814
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004815 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4816 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4817
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004818 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4819 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004820 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004821 client.
4822
4823 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4824 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4825 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4826
4827 Example :
4828 # remove the Server header from responses
4829 reqidel ^Server:.*
4830
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004831 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4832 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004833
4834
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004835rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4836rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004837 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4839 no | yes | yes | yes
4840 Arguments :
4841 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4842 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4843 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4844 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4845 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4846 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4847 ignores case.
4848
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004849 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4850 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4851
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004852 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4853 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4854 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4855 case-sensitive.
4856
4857 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004858 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4859 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4860 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004861
4862 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4863 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4864
4865 Example :
4866 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4867 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4868
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004869 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4870 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004871
4872
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004873rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4874rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004875 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4877 no | yes | yes | yes
4878 Arguments :
4879 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4880 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4881 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4882 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4883 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4884 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4885 ignores case.
4886
4887 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4888 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4889 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4890 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004891 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004892
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004893 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4894 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4895
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004896 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4897 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4898 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4899
4900 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4901 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4902 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4903 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4904 are not case-sensitive.
4905
4906 Example :
4907 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4908 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4909
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004910 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4911 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004912
4913
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004914server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004915 Declare a server in a backend
4916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4917 no | no | yes | yes
4918 Arguments :
4919 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004920 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4921 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004922
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004923 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4924 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4925 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4926 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004927 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4928 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4929 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4930 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4931 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4932 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004933
4934 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4935 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4936 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4937 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4938 adding this value to the client's port.
4939
4940 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4941 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004942 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004943
4944 Examples :
4945 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4946 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4947
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004948 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4949 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004950
4951
4952source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004953source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004954source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004955 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4957 yes | no | yes | yes
4958 Arguments :
4959 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4960 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4961 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4962 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4963
4964 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4965 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004966 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4967 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4968 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004969
4970 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4971 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4972 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4973 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4974 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4975 <addr>.
4976
4977 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4978 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4979 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4980 port.
4981
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004982 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4983 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4984 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4985 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4986 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4987 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4988 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4989 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4990 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4991 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4992 HTTP header.
4993
4994 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4995 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004996 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004997 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4998 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4999 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5000 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5001 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5002 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5003 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5004
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005005 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5006 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5007 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5008 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5009 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5010 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5011
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005012 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5013 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5014 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5015 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5016
5017 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5018 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5019 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5020 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5021 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5022 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5023
5024 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5025 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5026 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5027 there are two methods :
5028
5029 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5030 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5031 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5032 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5033 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5034 of the client ranges may be used.
5035
5036 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5037 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5038 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5039 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5040 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5041 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5042 same session.
5043
5044 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5045 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5046 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5047 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5048 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5049 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5050
5051 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5052 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5053 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005054 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005055
5056 Examples :
5057 backend private
5058 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5059 source 192.168.1.200
5060
5061 backend transparent_ssl1
5062 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5063 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5064
5065 backend transparent_ssl2
5066 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5067 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5068 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5069
5070 backend transparent_ssl3
5071 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5072 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5073 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5074
5075 backend transparent_smtp
5076 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5077 # with Tproxy version 4.
5078 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5079
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005080 backend transparent_http
5081 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5082 # proxy.
5083 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005085 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005086 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005088
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005089srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5090 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5092 yes | no | yes | yes
5093 Arguments :
5094 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5095 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5096 as explained at the top of this document.
5097
5098 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5099 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5100 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5101 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5102 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5103 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5104 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5105
5106 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5107 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5108 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5109 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5110 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005111 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005112 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005113 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005114
5115 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5116 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5117 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5118 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5119 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5120 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5121
5122 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5123 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5124
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005125 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5126 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005127
5128
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005129stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5130 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5132 no | no | yes | yes
5133
5134 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5135 matched.
5136
5137 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5138 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5139
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005140 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5141 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5142 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5143
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005144 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5145 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5146 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5147 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005148
5149 Example :
5150 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5151 backend stats_localhost
5152 stats enable
5153 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5154
5155 Example :
5156 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5157 backend stats_auth
5158 stats enable
5159 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5160 stats admin if TRUE
5161
5162 Example :
5163 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5164 userlist stats-auth
5165 group admin users admin
5166 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5167 group readonly users haproxy
5168 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5169
5170 backend stats_auth
5171 stats enable
5172 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5173 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5174 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5175 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5176
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005177 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5178 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5179 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005180
5181
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005182stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5183 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5185 yes | no | yes | yes
5186 Arguments :
5187 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5188
5189 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5190
5191 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5192 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5193 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5194 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5195 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5196 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5197
5198 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5199 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5200 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005201 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005202
5203 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5204 report using "stats scope".
5205
5206 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5207 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5208 unobvious parameters.
5209
5210 Example :
5211 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5212 backend public_www
5213 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5214 stats enable
5215 stats hide-version
5216 stats scope .
5217 stats uri /admin?stats
5218 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5219 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5220 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5221
5222 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5223 backend private_monitoring
5224 stats enable
5225 stats uri /admin?stats
5226 stats refresh 5s
5227
5228 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5229
5230
5231stats enable
5232 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5234 yes | no | yes | yes
5235 Arguments : none
5236
5237 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5238 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5239 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5240 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5241 - stats auth : no authentication
5242 - stats scope : no restriction
5243
5244 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5245 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5246 unobvious parameters.
5247
5248 Example :
5249 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5250 backend public_www
5251 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5252 stats enable
5253 stats hide-version
5254 stats scope .
5255 stats uri /admin?stats
5256 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5257 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5258 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5259
5260 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5261 backend private_monitoring
5262 stats enable
5263 stats uri /admin?stats
5264 stats refresh 5s
5265
5266 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5267
5268
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005269stats hide-version
5270 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5272 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005273 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005274
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005275 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5276 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5277 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5278 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5279 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5280 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005282 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5283 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5284 unobvious parameters.
5285
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005286 Example :
5287 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5288 backend public_www
5289 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005290 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005291 stats hide-version
5292 stats scope .
5293 stats uri /admin?stats
5294 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5295 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5296 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005297
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005298 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5299 backend private_monitoring
5300 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005301 stats uri /admin?stats
5302 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005303
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005304 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005305
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005306
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005307stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5308 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5309 Access control for statistics
5310
5311 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5312 no | no | yes | yes
5313
5314 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5315 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5316 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5317 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5318 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5319 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5320
5321 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5322 instance.
5323
5324 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5325 about ACL usage.
5326
5327
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005328stats realm <realm>
5329 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5331 yes | no | yes | yes
5332 Arguments :
5333 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5334 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5335 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5336
5337 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5338 using a backslash ('\').
5339
5340 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5341 only related to authentication.
5342
5343 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5344 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5345 unobvious parameters.
5346
5347 Example :
5348 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5349 backend public_www
5350 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5351 stats enable
5352 stats hide-version
5353 stats scope .
5354 stats uri /admin?stats
5355 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5356 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5357 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5358
5359 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5360 backend private_monitoring
5361 stats enable
5362 stats uri /admin?stats
5363 stats refresh 5s
5364
5365 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5366
5367
5368stats refresh <delay>
5369 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5371 yes | no | yes | yes
5372 Arguments :
5373 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5374 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5375 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5376 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5377 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5378 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5379
5380 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5381 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5382 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5383 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5384
5385 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5386 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5387 unobvious parameters.
5388
5389 Example :
5390 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5391 backend public_www
5392 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5393 stats enable
5394 stats hide-version
5395 stats scope .
5396 stats uri /admin?stats
5397 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5398 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5399 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5400
5401 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5402 backend private_monitoring
5403 stats enable
5404 stats uri /admin?stats
5405 stats refresh 5s
5406
5407 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5408
5409
5410stats scope { <name> | "." }
5411 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5413 yes | no | yes | yes
5414 Arguments :
5415 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5416 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5417 section in which the statement appears.
5418
5419 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5420 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5421 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5422 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5423 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5424 exists.
5425
5426 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5427 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5428 unobvious parameters.
5429
5430 Example :
5431 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5432 backend public_www
5433 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5434 stats enable
5435 stats hide-version
5436 stats scope .
5437 stats uri /admin?stats
5438 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5439 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5440 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5441
5442 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5443 backend private_monitoring
5444 stats enable
5445 stats uri /admin?stats
5446 stats refresh 5s
5447
5448 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5449
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005450
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005451stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005452 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5454 yes | no | yes | yes
5455
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005456 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005457 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5458
5459 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5460 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5461
5462 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5463 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005464 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005465
5466 Example :
5467 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5468 backend private_monitoring
5469 stats enable
5470 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5471 stats uri /admin?stats
5472 stats refresh 5s
5473
5474 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5475 global section.
5476
5477
5478stats show-legends
5479 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5480 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5481 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5482 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5483 - IP (socket, server)
5484 - cookie (backend, server)
5485
5486 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5487 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005488 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005489
5490 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5491
5492
5493stats show-node [ <name> ]
5494 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5496 yes | no | yes | yes
5497 Arguments:
5498 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5499 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5500
5501 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5502 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005503 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005504
5505 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5506 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5507 unobvious parameters.
5508
5509 Example:
5510 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5511 backend private_monitoring
5512 stats enable
5513 stats show-node Europe-1
5514 stats uri /admin?stats
5515 stats refresh 5s
5516
5517 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5518 section.
5519
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005520
5521stats uri <prefix>
5522 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5524 yes | no | yes | yes
5525 Arguments :
5526 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5527 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5528 query string.
5529
5530 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5531 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5532 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5533 possible to reach it in the application.
5534
5535 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005536 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005537 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5538 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5539 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5540 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5541
5542 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5543 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5544 an address or a port to statistics only.
5545
5546 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5547 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5548 unobvious parameters.
5549
5550 Example :
5551 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5552 backend public_www
5553 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5554 stats enable
5555 stats hide-version
5556 stats scope .
5557 stats uri /admin?stats
5558 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5559 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5560 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5561
5562 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5563 backend private_monitoring
5564 stats enable
5565 stats uri /admin?stats
5566 stats refresh 5s
5567
5568 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5569
5570
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005571stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5572 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005574 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005575
5576 Arguments :
5577 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5578 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5579 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5580 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5581
5582 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5583 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5584 the "stick-table" statement.
5585
5586 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5587 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5588 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5589 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5590 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5591
5592 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5593 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5594 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5595 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5596 transformation rules.
5597
5598 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5599 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5600 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5601 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5602 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5603 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5604 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5605
5606 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5607 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5608 ACL based conditions.
5609
5610 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5611 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5612 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5613 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5614
5615 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5616 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5617 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5618 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5619
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005620 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5621 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5622 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5623
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005624 Example :
5625 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5626 # last 30 minutes
5627 backend pop
5628 mode tcp
5629 balance roundrobin
5630 stick store-request src
5631 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5632 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5633 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5634
5635 backend smtp
5636 mode tcp
5637 balance roundrobin
5638 stick match src table pop
5639 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5640 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5641
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005642 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5643 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005644
5645
5646stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5647 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5649 no | no | yes | yes
5650
5651 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5652 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5653 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5654 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5655
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005656 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5657 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5658 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5659
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005660 Examples :
5661 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005662 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005663
5664 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5665 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5666 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5667
5668
5669 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5670 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5671 backend http
5672 mode http
5673 balance roundrobin
5674 stick on src table https
5675 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5676 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5677 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5678
5679 backend https
5680 mode tcp
5681 balance roundrobin
5682 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5683 stick on src
5684 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5685 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5686
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005687 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005688
5689
5690stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5691 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5693 no | no | yes | yes
5694
5695 Arguments :
5696 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5697 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5698 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5699 server is selected.
5700
5701 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5702 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5703 the "stick-table" statement.
5704
5705 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5706 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5707 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5708 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5709 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5710 address.
5711
5712 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5713 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5714 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5715 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5716 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5717 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5718 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5719 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5720 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5721 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5722
5723 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5724 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5725 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5726 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5727 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5728 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5729 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5730
5731 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5732 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5733 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5734 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5735
5736 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5737 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5738 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5739 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5740 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5741 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5742 another protocol or access method.
5743
5744 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5745 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5746 the request.
5747
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005748 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5749 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5750 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5751
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005752 Example :
5753 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5754 # last 30 minutes
5755 backend pop
5756 mode tcp
5757 balance roundrobin
5758 stick store-request src
5759 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5760 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5761 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5762
5763 backend smtp
5764 mode tcp
5765 balance roundrobin
5766 stick match src table pop
5767 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5768 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5769
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005770 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5771 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005772
5773
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005774stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005775 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5776 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005777 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005779 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005780
5781 Arguments :
5782 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5783 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5784 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5785 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5786
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005787 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5788 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5789 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5790 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5791
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005792 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5793 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5794 instance.
5795
5796 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5797 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5798 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5799 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5800 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5801 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005802 to 32 characters.
5803
5804 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5805 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5806 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5807 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5808 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5809 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005810
5811 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005812 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5813 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005814 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5815 increase.
5816
5817 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005818 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5819 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5820 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005821
5822 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5823 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5824 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5825 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5826 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5827 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5828 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5829 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5830 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5831 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5832 parameter (see below).
5833
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005834 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5835 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5836 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5837 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5838 soft restart.
5839
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005840 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5841
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005842 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5843 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5844 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5845 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5846 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005847 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005848 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5849 if not expiration delay is specified.
5850
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005851 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5852 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5853 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5854 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005855 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5856 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5857 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5858 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5859 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5860 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5861 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5862 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5863 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5864 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5865 types and their arguments.
5866
5867 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5868 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5869 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5870 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5871
5872 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5873 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5874 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5875 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5876
5877 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5878 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5879 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5880 they were received.
5881
5882 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5883 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5884 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5885 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5886 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5887
5888 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5889 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5890 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5891 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5892 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5893
5894 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5895 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5896 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5897
5898 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5899 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5900 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5901 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5902 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5903
5904 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5905 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5906 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5907 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5908 the client side.
5909
5910 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5911 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5912 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5913 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5914 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5915 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5916 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5917
5918 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5919 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5920 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5921 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5922 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5923 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5924 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5925
5926 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5927 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5928 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5929 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5930 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5931 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5932
5933 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5934 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5935 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5936 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5937
5938 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5939 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5940 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5941 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5942 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5943 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5944 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5945 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5946 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5947 recommended for better fairness.
5948
5949 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5950 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5951 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5952 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5953
5954 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5955 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5956 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5957 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5958 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5959 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5960 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5961 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5962 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5963 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005964
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005965 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5966 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005967 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5968 reference it.
5969
5970 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5971 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5972 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5973 as an exclusive stickiness.
5974
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005975 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5976 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5977 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5978 something that can be ignored.
5979
5980 Example:
5981 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5982 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5983 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5984 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5985
5986 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005987 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005988
5989
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005990stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5991 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5993 no | no | yes | yes
5994
5995 Arguments :
5996 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5997 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5998 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5999 server is selected.
6000
6001 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6002 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6003 the "stick-table" statement.
6004
6005 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6006 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6007 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6008 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6009
6010 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6011 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6012 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6013 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6014 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6015 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006016 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006017 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6018 rules.
6019
6020 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6021 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6022 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6023 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6024 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6025 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6026 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6027
6028 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6029 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6030 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6031 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6032
6033 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6034 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6035 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6036 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6037 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6038 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6039 another protocol or access method.
6040
6041 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6042
6043 Example :
6044 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6045 backend https
6046 mode tcp
6047 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006048 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006049 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006050
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006051 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6052 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6053
6054 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6055 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6056 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6057
6058 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6059 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006060
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006061 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6062 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6063 # at offset 44.
6064
6065 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6066 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6067
6068 # Learn on response if server hello.
6069 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006070
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006071 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6072 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6073
6074 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6075 extraction.
6076
6077
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006078tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6079 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6081 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006082 Arguments :
6083 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6084 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6085 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006086
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006087 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006088
6089 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6090 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006091 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6092 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6093 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6094 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6095 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6096 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006097
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006098 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6099 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6100 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6101 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006102
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006103 Three types of actions are supported :
6104 - accept :
6105 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6106 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6107 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006108
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006109 - reject :
6110 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6111 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6112 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6113 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6114 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6115 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6116 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6117 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6118 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6119 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6120 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6121 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006122
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006123 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6124 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6125 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6126 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6127 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6128 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6129 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6130 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6131 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006132
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006133 These actions take one or two arguments :
6134 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6135 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6136 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006137
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006138 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6139 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6140 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6141 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006142
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006143 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6144 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6145 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6146 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6147 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6148 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6149 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6150 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6151 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6152 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006153
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006154 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6155 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6156 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006157
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006158 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6159 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6160 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006161
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006162 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006163 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006164 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006165
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006166 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6167 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6168 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006169
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006170 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6171 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6172 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006173
6174 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6175
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006176 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006177
6178
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006179tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6180 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006182 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006183 Arguments :
6184 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6185 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6186 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006187
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006188 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006189
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006190 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6191 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6192 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6193 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6194 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006195
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006196 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6197 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6198 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6199 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6200 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6201 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6202 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6203 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6204 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006205
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006206 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6207 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6208 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6209 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006210
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006211 Three types of actions are supported :
6212 - accept :
6213 - reject :
6214 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006216 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6217 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006218
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006219 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6220 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6221 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6222 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6223 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6224 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006225
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006226 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006227 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6228 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006229
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006230 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006231 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6232 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6233 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6234 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6235 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006236
6237 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006238 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6239 # and reject everything else.
6240 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6241 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006242 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006243 tcp-request content reject
6244
6245 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006246 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6247 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6248 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006249 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006250
6251 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6252 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6253 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006254 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006255 tcp-request content reject
6256
6257 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6258 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6259
6260 frontend http
6261 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6262 # protecting all our sites
6263 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6264 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6265 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6266 ...
6267 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6268
6269 backend http_dynamic
6270 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6271 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6272 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6273 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6274 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6275 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6276 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006278 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006279
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006280 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006281
6282
6283tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6284 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006286 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006287 Arguments :
6288 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6289 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6290 as explained at the top of this document.
6291
6292 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6293 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6294 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6295 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6296 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6297
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006298 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6299 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6300 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6301 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6302
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006303 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6304 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006305 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006306 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006307 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6308 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6309 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6310 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006311
6312 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6313 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6314 it pass through unaffected.
6315
6316 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6317 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6318 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006319 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006320 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6321 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006322 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6323 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6324 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006325
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006326 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006327 "timeout client".
6328
6329
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006330tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6331 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6333 no | no | yes | yes
6334 Arguments :
6335 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6336 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6337 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6338
6339 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6340
6341 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6342 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6343 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6344 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006345 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006346
6347 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6348
6349 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6350 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6351 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6352 inserted.
6353
6354 Two types of actions are supported :
6355 - accept :
6356 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6357 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6358 the rules evaluation.
6359
6360 - reject :
6361 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6362 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006363 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006364
6365 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6366 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6367 for changing the default action to a reject.
6368
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006369 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6370 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6371 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6372 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006373 period.
6374
6375 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6376
6377 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6378
6379
6380tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6381 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6383 no | no | yes | yes
6384 Arguments :
6385 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6386 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6387 as explained at the top of this document.
6388
6389 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6390
6391
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006392timeout check <timeout>
6393 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6394 established.
6395
6396 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6397 yes | no | yes | yes
6398 Arguments:
6399 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6400 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6401 as explained at the top of this document.
6402
6403 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6404 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6405 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6406 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006407 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6408 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6409 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006410
6411 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6412 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6413
6414 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6415 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006416 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006417
6418 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6419 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6420 forget about it.
6421
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006422 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6423 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006424
6425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006426timeout client <timeout>
6427timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6428 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6430 yes | yes | yes | no
6431 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006432 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006433 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6434 as explained at the top of this document.
6435
6436 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6437 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6438 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6439 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6440 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6441 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6442 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6443 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006444 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006445 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006446 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6447 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6448 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006449
6450 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6451 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6452 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6453 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6454 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6455 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6456
6457 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6458 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6459 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6460
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006461 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006462
6463
6464timeout connect <timeout>
6465timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6466 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6468 yes | no | yes | yes
6469 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006470 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006471 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6472 as explained at the top of this document.
6473
6474 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006475 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006476 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006477 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006478 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6479 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006480
6481 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6482 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6483 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6484 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6485 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6486 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6487
6488 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6489 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6490 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6491
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006492 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6493 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006494
6495
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006496timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6497 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6499 yes | yes | yes | yes
6500 Arguments :
6501 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6502 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6503 as explained at the top of this document.
6504
6505 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6506 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6507 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6508 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6509 once the request has started to present itself.
6510
6511 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6512 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6513 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6514 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6515 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6516
6517 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6518 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6519 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6520 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6521
6522 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6523 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6524 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6525 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6526 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006527 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006528
6529 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6530 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6531 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6532 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6533
6534 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6535
6536
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006537timeout http-request <timeout>
6538 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006540 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006541 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006542 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006543 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6544 as explained at the top of this document.
6545
6546 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6547 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6548 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6549 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6550 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6551 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6552 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6553 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6554
6555 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6556 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006557 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6558 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006559
6560 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6561 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6562 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6563 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6564 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6565
6566 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006567 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6568 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6569 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006570
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006571 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006572
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006573
6574timeout queue <timeout>
6575 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6577 yes | no | yes | yes
6578 Arguments :
6579 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6580 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6581 as explained at the top of this document.
6582
6583 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6584 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6585 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6586 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6587 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6588
6589 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6590 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6591 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6592 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6593
6594 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6595
6596
6597timeout server <timeout>
6598timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6599 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6601 yes | no | yes | yes
6602 Arguments :
6603 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6604 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6605 as explained at the top of this document.
6606
6607 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6608 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6609 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6610 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6611 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6612 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6613 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6614
6615 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6616 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6617 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6618 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6619 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006620 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006621 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006622 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6623 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6624 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6625 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006626
6627 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6628 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6629 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6630 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6631 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6632 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6633
6634 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6635 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6636 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6637
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006638 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006639
6640
6641timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006642 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6644 yes | yes | yes | yes
6645 Arguments :
6646 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6647 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6648 as explained at the top of this document.
6649
6650 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6651 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6652 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6653
6654 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6655 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6656 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6657 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006658 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006659
6660 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6661
6662
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006663timeout tunnel <timeout>
6664 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6666 yes | no | yes | yes
6667 Arguments :
6668 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6669 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6670 as explained at the top of this document.
6671
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006672 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006673 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6674 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6675 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6676 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6677 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6678 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6679 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6680 specified.
6681
6682 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6683 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6684 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6685 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6686 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6687
6688 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6689 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6690 forget about it.
6691
6692 Example :
6693 defaults http
6694 option http-server-close
6695 timeout connect 5s
6696 timeout client 30s
6697 timeout client 30s
6698 timeout server 30s
6699 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6700
6701 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6702
6703
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006704transparent (deprecated)
6705 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006707 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006708 Arguments : none
6709
6710 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6711 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6712 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6713 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6714 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6715 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6716 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6717 appropriate server.
6718
6719 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6720
6721 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6722 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6723
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006724 See also: "option transparent"
6725
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006726unique-id-format <string>
6727 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6729 yes | yes | yes | no
6730 Arguments :
6731 <string> is a log-format string.
6732
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006733 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6734 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6735 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6736 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006737
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006738 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6739 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6740 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6741 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6742 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6743 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6744 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6745 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006746
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006747 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6748 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006749
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006750 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006751
6752 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6753
6754 will generate:
6755
6756 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6757
6758 See also: "unique-id-header"
6759
6760unique-id-header <name>
6761 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6763 yes | yes | yes | no
6764 Arguments :
6765 <name> is the name of the header.
6766
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006767 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6768 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006769
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006770 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006771
6772 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6773 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6774
6775 will generate:
6776
6777 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6778
6779 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006780
6781use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6782use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006783 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6785 no | yes | yes | no
6786 Arguments :
6787 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006789 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006790
6791 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6792 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6793 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006794 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6795 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6796 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6797 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006798
6799 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6800 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6801 assign the backend.
6802
6803 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6804 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6805 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6806 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6807 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6808 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6809
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006810 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006811 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006812 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6813 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6814 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6815
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006816 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006817
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006818
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006819use-server <server> if <condition>
6820use-server <server> unless <condition>
6821 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6823 no | no | yes | yes
6824 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006825 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006826
6827 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6828
6829 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6830 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6831 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6832
6833 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6834 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6835 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6836 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6837 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6838 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6839 matches will assign the server.
6840
6841 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6842 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6843 with the next rules until one matches.
6844
6845 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6846 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6847 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6848 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6849
6850 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6851 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6852 stripped.
6853
6854 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6855 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6856 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6857 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6858
6859 Example :
6860 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6861 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6862 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6863 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6864 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6865 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6866 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6867 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6868 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6869
6870 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6871
6872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010068735. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006874------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006875
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006876The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6877which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6878arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6879settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6880after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6881Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6882address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006884 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006885 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006887The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006888
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02006889addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006890 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6891 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6892 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6893 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6894 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006896 Supported in default-server: No
6897
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006898backup
6899 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6900 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6901 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6902 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6903 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6904 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006905
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006906 Supported in default-server: No
6907
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006908check
6909 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006910 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6911 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6912 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6913 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6914 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6915 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6916 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6917 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6918 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6919 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006920
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006921 Supported in default-server: No
6922
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02006923ciphers <ciphers>
6924 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
6925 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
6926 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
6927 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
6928 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
6929 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
6930 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
6931 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
6932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006933cookie <value>
6934 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6935 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6936 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6937 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6938 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6939 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6940 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006942 Supported in default-server: No
6943
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006944disabled
6945 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6946 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6947 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6948 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6949 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6950
6951 Supported in default-server: No
6952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006953error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006954 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6955 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6956 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006958 Supported in default-server: Yes
6959
6960 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006962fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006963 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6964 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6965 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6966
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006967 Supported in default-server: Yes
6968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006969id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006970 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6971 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6972 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006974 Supported in default-server: No
6975
6976inter <delay>
6977fastinter <delay>
6978downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006979 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6980 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6981 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6982 between checks depending on the server state :
6983
6984 Server state | Interval used
6985 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6986 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6987 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6988 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6989 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6990 or yet unchecked. |
6991 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6992 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6993 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006995 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6996 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6997 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6998 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6999 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7000 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7001 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7002 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7003 servers.
7004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007005 Supported in default-server: Yes
7006
7007maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007008 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7009 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7010 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7011 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7012 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7013 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7014 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7015 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007017 Supported in default-server: Yes
7018
7019maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007020 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7021 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7022 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7023 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7024 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7025 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7026 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007028 Supported in default-server: Yes
7029
7030minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007031 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7032 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7033 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7034 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7035 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7036 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007037 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007038 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007040 Supported in default-server: Yes
7041
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007042nosslv3
7043 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7044 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7045 using any configuration option.
7046
7047notlsv1
7048 This option disables support for TLSv1 when SSL is used to communicate with
7049 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7050 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
7051 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers.
7052
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007053non-stick
7054 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7055 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7056 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007058observe <mode>
7059 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7060 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7061 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7062 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7063 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7064 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007065 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007067 Supported in default-server: No
7068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007069 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7070
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007071on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007072 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7073 Currently, four modes are available:
7074 - fastinter: force fastinter
7075 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7076 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7077 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7078 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007080 Supported in default-server: Yes
7081
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007082 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7083
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007084on-marked-down <action>
7085 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7086 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007087 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7088 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7089 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7090 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7091 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7092 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7093 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7094 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007095
7096 Actions are disabled by default
7097
7098 Supported in default-server: Yes
7099
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007100on-marked-up <action>
7101 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7102 Currently one action is available:
7103 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7104 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7105 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7106 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7107 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7108 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7109 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7110 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7111
7112 Actions are disabled by default
7113
7114 Supported in default-server: Yes
7115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007116port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007117 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7118 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7119 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7120 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7121 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7122 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7123
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007124 Supported in default-server: Yes
7125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007126redir <prefix>
7127 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7128 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7129 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7130 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7131 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7132 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7133 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7134 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007135 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007136 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7137 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7138 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7139 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7140 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7141
7142 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007144 Supported in default-server: No
7145
7146rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007147 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7148 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7149 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007151 Supported in default-server: Yes
7152
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007153send-proxy
7154 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7155 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7156 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7157 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7158 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7159 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7160 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7161 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7162 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
7163 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
7164 option of the "bind" keyword.
7165
7166 Supported in default-server: No
7167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007168slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007169 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7170 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7171 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7172 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7173 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7174 parameters :
7175
7176 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7177 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7178
7179 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7180 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7181 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7182 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7183
7184 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7185 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7186 seen as failed.
7187
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007188 Supported in default-server: Yes
7189
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007190source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007191source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007192source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007193 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7194 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7195 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7196 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7197
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007198 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7199 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7200 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7201 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7202 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7203 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7204 server.
7205
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007206 Supported in default-server: No
7207
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007208ssl
7209 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7210 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7211 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7212 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7213 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications.
7214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007215track [<proxy>/]<server>
7216 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7217 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7218 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7219 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7220 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007222 Supported in default-server: No
7223
7224weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007225 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7226 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7227 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007228 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7229 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7230 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7231 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7232 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7233 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007235 Supported in default-server: Yes
7236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007237
72386. HTTP header manipulation
7239---------------------------
7240
7241In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7242response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7243request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7244which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7245against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7246to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7247passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7248headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7249never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7250
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007251There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7252(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7253rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7254messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7255in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007256happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007257add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7258normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007260This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7261in section 4.2 :
7262
7263 - reqadd <string>
7264 - reqallow <search>
7265 - reqiallow <search>
7266 - reqdel <search>
7267 - reqidel <search>
7268 - reqdeny <search>
7269 - reqideny <search>
7270 - reqpass <search>
7271 - reqipass <search>
7272 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7273 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7274 - reqtarpit <search>
7275 - reqitarpit <search>
7276 - rspadd <string>
7277 - rspdel <search>
7278 - rspidel <search>
7279 - rspdeny <search>
7280 - rspideny <search>
7281 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7282 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7283
7284With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7285is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7286parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7287prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7288Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7289
7290 \t for a tab
7291 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7292 \n for a new line (LF)
7293 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7294 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7295 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7296 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7297 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7298
7299The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7300portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7301above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7302regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
73039 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7304is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7305
7306The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7307after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7308
7309Notes related to these keywords :
7310---------------------------------
7311 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7312 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7313 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7314
7315 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7316 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7317 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7318
7319 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7320 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7321 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7322 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7323 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7324
7325 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7326 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7327 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7328 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7329 useless headers before adding new ones.
7330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007331 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007332 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7333
7334 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7335 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7336 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7337
7338 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7339 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007340 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007341
7342
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010073437. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7344------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007345
7346The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7347content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7348from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7349simple :
7350
7351 - define test criteria with sets of values
7352 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7353
7354The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7355
7356In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7357
7358 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7359
7360This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7361Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7362and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7363an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7364of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7365
7366ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7367'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7368which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7369
7370There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7371performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7372
7373The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7374
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007375 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7376 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007377 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7378
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007379The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7380specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7381possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007382multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7383be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7384needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7385space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7386match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7387lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7388duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007389to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007390instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007391
7392 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7393
7394In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7395the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7396case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7397too.
7398
7399Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7400a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7401ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7402
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007403Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007404
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007405 - integers or integer ranges
7406 - strings
7407 - regular expressions
7408 - IP addresses and networks
7409
7410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074117.1. Matching integers
7412----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007413
7414Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7415that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7416expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7417may be omitted.
7418
7419For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7420unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7421representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7422
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007423As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7424two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7425instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7426ranges and operators.
7427
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007428For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007429operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7430Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7431of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007433Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007434
7435 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7436 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7437 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7438 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7439 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7440
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007441For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007442
7443 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7444
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007445This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7446
7447 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074507.2. Matching strings
7451---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007452
7453String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7454exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7455characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7456string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7457to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007458before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007459
7460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074617.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7462-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007463
7464Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7465they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7466possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7467passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7468the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007469the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7470match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007471
7472
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020074737.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007474----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007475
7476IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7477netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7478within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007479host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007480difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7481at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7482does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7483parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007484
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007485IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7486Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7487trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7488IPv6 patterns.
7489
7490HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7491following situations :
7492 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7493 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7494 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7495 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7496 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7497 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7498 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7499 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7500 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7501 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7502
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075047.5. Available matching criteria
7505--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075077.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7508------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007509
7510A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7511analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007512addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007513
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007514always_false
7515 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7516 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7517
7518always_true
7519 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7520 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7521
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007522avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007523avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007524 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7525 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7526 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7527 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7528 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7529 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7530 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7531 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7532 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7533 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7534 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007535
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007536be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007537be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007538 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7539 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7540 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7541 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7542 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007543
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007544be_id <integer>
7545 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7546 backend it was called.
7547
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007548be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007549be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007550 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7551 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7552 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7553 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7554 sucking of an online dictionary).
7555
7556 Example :
7557 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7558 backend dynamic
7559 mode http
7560 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7561 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007562
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007563connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007564connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007565 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007566 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007567 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7568
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007569 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7570 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007571
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007572 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007573 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7574 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7575 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7576 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7577 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007578 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007579
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007580 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7581 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7582 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7583 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007584
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007585dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007586 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7587 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007588
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007589dst_conn <integer>
7590 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7591 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7592 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7593 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7594 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7595 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7596
7597dst_port <integer>
7598 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7599 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7600
7601fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007602fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007603 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7604 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7605 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7606 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7607 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7608 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7609 criteria.
7610
7611fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007612 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007613 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007614
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007615fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007616fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007617 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7618 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7619 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7620 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7621 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7622 the rate to go down below the limit.
7623
7624 Example :
7625 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7626 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7627 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7628 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7629 frontend mail
7630 bind :25
7631 mode tcp
7632 maxconn 100
7633 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7634 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7635 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7636 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007637
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007638nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007639nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007640 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7641 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7642 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7643 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7644 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007645
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007646queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007647queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007648 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7649 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7650 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7651 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7652 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7653 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7654 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7655
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007656sc1_bytes_in_rate
7657sc2_bytes_in_rate
7658 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7659 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7660 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7661
7662sc1_bytes_out_rate
7663sc2_bytes_out_rate
7664 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7665 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7666 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7667
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007668sc1_clr_gpc0
7669sc2_clr_gpc0
7670 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7671 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7672 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7673 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7674 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7675 was verified :
7676
7677 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7678 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7679 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7680 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7681 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7682 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7683 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7684
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007685sc1_conn_cnt
7686sc2_conn_cnt
7687 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7688 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7689
7690sc1_conn_cur
7691sc2_conn_cur
7692 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7693 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7694 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7695
7696sc1_conn_rate
7697sc2_conn_rate
7698 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7699 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7700 See also src_conn_rate.
7701
7702sc1_get_gpc0
7703sc2_get_gpc0
7704 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7705 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7706
7707sc1_http_err_cnt
7708sc2_http_err_cnt
7709 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7710 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7711 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7712
7713sc1_http_err_rate
7714sc2_http_err_rate
7715 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7716 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7717 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7718 src_http_err_rate.
7719
7720sc1_http_req_cnt
7721sc2_http_req_cnt
7722 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7723 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7724 src_http_req_cnt.
7725
7726sc1_http_req_rate
7727sc2_http_req_rate
7728 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7729 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7730 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7731 src_http_req_rate.
7732
7733sc1_inc_gpc0
7734sc2_inc_gpc0
7735 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7736 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7737 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7738 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7739 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7740 when a first ACL was verified :
7741
7742 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7743 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7744 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7745
7746sc1_kbytes_in
7747sc2_kbytes_in
7748 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7749 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7750 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7751 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7752
7753sc1_kbytes_out
7754sc2_kbytes_out
7755 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7756 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7757 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7758 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7759
7760sc1_sess_cnt
7761sc2_sess_cnt
7762 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7763 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7764 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7765 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007766 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007767 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7768
7769sc1_sess_rate
7770sc2_sess_rate
7771 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7772 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7773 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7774 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7775 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007776 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007777
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007778so_id <integer>
7779 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7780
7781src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007782 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
7783 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
7784 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007785
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007786src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007787src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007788 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7789 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7790 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007791 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007792
7793src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007794src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007795 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7796 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7797 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007798 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007799
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007800src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7801src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7802 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7803 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7804 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7805 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7806 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7807 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7808
7809 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7810 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7811 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7812 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7813 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7814 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7815 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7816
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007817src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007818src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007819 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7820 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7821 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007822 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007823
7824src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007825src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007826 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7827 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7828 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007829 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007830
7831src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007832src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007833 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7834 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7835 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007836 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007837
7838src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007839src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007840 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7841 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7842 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007843 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007844
7845src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007846src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007847 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7848 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7849 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007850 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007851
7852src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007853src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007854 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7855 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7856 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7857 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007858 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007859
7860src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007861src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007862 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7863 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7864 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007865 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007866
7867src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007868src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007869 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7870 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7871 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7872 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007873 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007874
7875src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007876src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007877 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7878 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7879 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7880 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7881 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7882 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7883
7884 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7885 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007886 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007887
7888src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007889src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007890 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7891 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7892 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7893 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007894 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007895
7896src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007897src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007898 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7899 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7900 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7901 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007902 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007903
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007904src_port <integer>
7905 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007906
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007907src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007908src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007909 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7910 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7911 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7912 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007913 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007914
7915src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007916src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007917 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7918 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7919 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7920 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007921 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007922
7923src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007924src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007925 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007926 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7927 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007928 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7929 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7930 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007931 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007932
7933 Example :
7934 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7935 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7936 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7937 listen ssh
7938 bind :22
7939 mode tcp
7940 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007941 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007942 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7943 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7944
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007945srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007946 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7947 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7948 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7949 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7950
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007951srv_id <integer>
7952 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7953
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007954srv_is_up(<server>)
7955srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7956 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7957 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7958 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7959 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7960 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7961 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7962 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7963 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7964
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007965table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007966table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007967 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7968 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7969
7970table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007971table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007972 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7973 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7974 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7975
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020079777.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7978---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007979
7980A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7981during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007982through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7983keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007984
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02007985is_ssl
7986 Returns true when the incoming connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer
7987 and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared with
7988 a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
7989
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007990rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7991 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7992 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7993 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02007994 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
7995 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
7996 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007997
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007998req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007999 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008000 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8001 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8002 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8003 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8004 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8005 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8006
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008007req_proto_http
8008 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8009 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008010 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008011 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8012 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8013
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008014req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008015req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008016 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8017 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8018 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8019 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8020 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8021 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8022 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8023 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8024
8025req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008026req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008027 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8028 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8029 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8030 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8031 cookies.
8032
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008033req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8034 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8035 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8036 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008037 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8038 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8039 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008040
8041req_ssl_sni <string>
8042 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8043 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8044 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8045 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8046 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8047 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8048 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008049 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8050 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
8051 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
8052 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008053
8054 Examples :
8055 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8056 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8057 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8058 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8059 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8060
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008061req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8062 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8063 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8064 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8065 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8066 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8067 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008068 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8069 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
8070 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
8071 option.
8072
8073ssl_sni <string>
8074 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8075 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8076 the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8077 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8078 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8079 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires that
8080 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8081
8082ssl_has_sni
8083 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8084 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer. Returns true
8085 when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires that
8086 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8087
8088ssl_sni <string>
8089 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8090 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8091 the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8092 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8093 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8094 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. See also ssl_sni_end
8095 and ssl_sni_req below. This requires that the SSL library is build with
8096 support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8097
8098ssl_sni_end <string>
8099 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8100 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8101 the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8102 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8103 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8104 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires that
8105 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8106
8107ssl_sni_req <regex>
8108 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8109 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8110 the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8111 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8112 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8113 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires that
8114 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008115
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008116wait_end
8117 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8118 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8119 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8120 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8121 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8122 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8123 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8124 inspection.
8125
8126 Examples :
8127 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8128 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8129 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8130
8131 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8132 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8133 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8134 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8135 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8136 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8137 tcp-request content reject
8138
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081407.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8141--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008142
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008143A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008144application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8145read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8146than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8147
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008148base <string>
8149 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8150 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8151 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8152 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8153 See also "path" and "uri".
8154
8155base_beg <string>
8156 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8157 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8158 "path_beg".
8159
8160base_dir <string>
8161 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8162 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8163 "path_dir" instead.
8164
8165base_dom <string>
8166 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8167 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8168 instead.
8169
8170base_end <string>
8171 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8172 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8173
8174base_len <integer>
8175 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8176 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8177
8178base_reg <regex>
8179 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8180 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8181 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8182 and all "base_" criteria.
8183
8184base_sub <string>
8185 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8186 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8187 also "base_dir".
8188
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008189cook(<name>) <string>
8190 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8191 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8192 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8193 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8194 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8195 sent by the server.
8196
8197 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8198 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8199 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8200
8201 cook(profile) silver gold
8202
8203cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8204 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8205 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8206 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8207
8208cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8209 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8210 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8211 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8212 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8213 server.
8214
8215cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8216 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8217 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8218 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8219 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8220 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8221
8222cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8223 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8224 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8225 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8226 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8227
8228cook_end(<name>) <string>
8229 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8230 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8231 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8232
8233cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8234 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8235 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8236 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8237 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8238 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8239
8240cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8241 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8242 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8243 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8244 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8245 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8246
8247cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8248 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8249 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8250 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8251
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008252cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8253 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8254 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8255 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8256 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8257 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8258
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008259hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008260hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008261 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8262 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8263 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8264 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008265 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8266 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8267 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8268 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8269 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008270
8271 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008272 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008273 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8274
8275 hdr(Connection) -i close
8276
8277hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008278hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008279 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8280 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8281 response headers sent by the server.
8282
8283hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008284hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008285 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8286 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8287 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8288 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8289 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8290 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8291 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8292
8293hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008294hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008295 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8296 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8297 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8298 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8299 headers sent by the server.
8300
8301hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008302hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008303 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8304 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8305 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8306 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8307 server.
8308
8309hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008310hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008311 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8312 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8313 response headers sent by the server.
8314
8315hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008316hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8317 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8318 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8319 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008320 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8321
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008322hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008323hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008324 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8325 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8326 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8327 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8328
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008329hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008330hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008331 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008332 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8333 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8334 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8335 response headers sent by the server.
8336
8337hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008338hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008339 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8340 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8341 response headers sent by the server.
8342
8343hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008344hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008345 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8346 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8347 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8348 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8349
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008350http_auth(<userlist>)
8351http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008352 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8353 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8354 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8355 of specified groups.
8356
8357 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8358
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008359http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008360 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8361 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8362 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8363 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8364
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008365method <string>
8366 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8367 already check for most common methods.
8368
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008369path <string>
8370 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8371 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8372 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8373
8374path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008375 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8376 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008377
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008378path_dir <string>
8379 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8380 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8381 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8382 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8383
8384path_dom <string>
8385 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8386 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8387 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8388
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008389path_end <string>
8390 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8391 control file name extension.
8392
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008393path_len <integer>
8394 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8395 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8396
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008397path_reg <regex>
8398 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8399 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8400 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8401
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008402path_sub <string>
8403 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8404 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8405 "path_dir".
8406
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008407payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8408 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8409 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8410 strings.
8411
8412payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8413 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8414 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8415 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8416 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8417 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8418
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008419req_ver <string>
8420 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8421 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8422
8423status <integer>
8424 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8425 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8426 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8427
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008428url <string>
8429 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008430 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008431
8432url_beg <string>
8433 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008434 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8435 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008436
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008437url_dir <string>
8438 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8439 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8440 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8441 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8442
8443url_dom <string>
8444 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8445 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8446 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8447
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008448url_end <string>
8449 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8450 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008451
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008452url_ip <address>
8453 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8454 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8455 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008456
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008457url_len <integer>
8458 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8459 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8460
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008461url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008462 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8463 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008464 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008465 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008466
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008467url_reg <regex>
8468 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8469 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008470 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008471
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008472url_sub <string>
8473 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8474 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008475
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008476urlp(<name>) <string>
8477 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8478 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8479
8480 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8481 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8482
8483urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8484 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8485 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8486 protocol scheme.
8487
8488urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8489 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8490 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8491 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8492 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8493
8494urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8495 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8496 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8497 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8498 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8499
8500urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8501 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8502
8503urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008504 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8505 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008506
8507urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8508 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8509 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8510
8511urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8512 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8513 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8514 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8515 "urlp_" criteria.
8516
8517urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8518 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8519 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8520 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8521
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02008522urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
8523 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
8524 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
8525 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
8526 negative data.
8527
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085297.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8530---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008531
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008532Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8533every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008534order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008536ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8537---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008538FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008539HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008540HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8541HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008542HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8543HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8544HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8545HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8546LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008547METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8548METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8549METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8550METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8551METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8552METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008553RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008554REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008555TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008556WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8557---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008558
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085607.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8561----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008563Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8564combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008566 - AND (implicit)
8567 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8568 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008570A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008572 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008574Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8575indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008577For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8578"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8579requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8580is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008582 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8583 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8584 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8585 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008587To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8588and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008590 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8591 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8592 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8593 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008595 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8596 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8597 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8598 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008599
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008600It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8601expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8602be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008603the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008604
8605 The following rule :
8606
8607 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8608 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8609
8610 Can also be written that way :
8611
8612 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8613
8614It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8615to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8616simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8617sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8618good use is the following :
8619
8620 With named ACLs :
8621
8622 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8623 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8624 monitor fail if site_dead
8625
8626 With anonymous ACLs :
8627
8628 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008630See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008631
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008632
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010086337.8. Pattern extraction
8634-----------------------
8635
8636The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8637response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8638for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8639
8640All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8641"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8642begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8643arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8644much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8645equivalent used in ACLs.
8646
8647The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8648
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008649 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
8650 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
8651 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
8652 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
8653 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
8654 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
8655 requested objects by host/path.
8656
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008657 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008658 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8659 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8660 according to RFC 4291.
8661
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008662 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8663 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8664 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008665 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8666 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8667 according to RFC 4291.
8668
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008669 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8670 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8671 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8672 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8673 type integer and only works with such tables.
8674
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008675 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
8676 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8677 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
8678 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
8679 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
8680 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
8681 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008682 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008683
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008684 is_ssl This checks the data layer used by incoming connection, and
8685 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer,
8686 otherwise zero.
8687
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008688 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
8689 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8690 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8691 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
8692 wiser to use "url" instead.
8693
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008694 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008695 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8696 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8697 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8698 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008699
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008700 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008701 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8702 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8703 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8704 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8705 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8706 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8707 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8708 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008709
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008710 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
8711 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
8712 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
8713 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
8714
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008715 ssl_has_sni This checks the data layer used by incoming connection, and
8716 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer
8717 and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
8718 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
8719 support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8720
8721 ssl_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
8722 connection made via an SSL/TLS data layer and locally deciphered
8723 by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching the HTTPS
8724 host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have been
8725 built with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8726
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008727 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
8728 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8729 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8730 keep them in caches. See also "path".
8731
8732 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
8733 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
8734 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
8735 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
8736 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
8737 table for a given source address.
8738
8739 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
8740 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
8741
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008742 url_param(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008743 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
8744 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
8745 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url
8746 (e.g. http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8747 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008748
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008749 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008750 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8751 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8752 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8753 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008754
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008755 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8756 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8757 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8758 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8759 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8760 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8761 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008762
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008763 Example :
8764 listen tse-farm
8765 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8766 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8767 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8768 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8769 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8770 persist rdp-cookie
8771 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8772 # This is only useful makes sense if
8773 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8774 stick-table type string size 204800
8775 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8776 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8777 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008778
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008779 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8780 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008781
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008782 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008783 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008784 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
8785 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
8786 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
8787 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
8788 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
8789 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008790
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008791 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008792
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008793 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008794 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
8795 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
8796 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
8797
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008798 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8799 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8800 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8801 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8802 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008803
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008804 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008805
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008806
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008807The currently available list of transformations include :
8808
8809 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8810 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8811 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8812
8813 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8814 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8815 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8816
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008817 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008818 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8819 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8820 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8821 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8822
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088248. Logging
8825----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008826
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008827One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8828provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8829very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8830provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8831state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008832to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008833headers.
8834
8835In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8836about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8837send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8838
8839 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8840 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8841 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8842 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8843 at the termination.
8844
8845The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8846allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8847as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8848while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8849real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8850delay.
8851
8852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088538.1. Log levels
8854---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008855
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008856TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008857source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008858HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8859in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8860track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8861syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8862about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008863
8864
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088658.2. Log formats
8866----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008867
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008868HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008869and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8870slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8871options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008872
8873 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8874 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8875 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8876 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8877 extents.
8878
8879 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8880 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8881 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8882 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8883 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8884
8885 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8886 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8887 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8888 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8889 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8890
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008891 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8892 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8893 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8894 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8895
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008896 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8897
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008898Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8899specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8900field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8901servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8902always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8903identifier.
8904
8905Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8906 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8907 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8908 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8909 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8910
8911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089128.2.1. Default log format
8913-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008914
8915This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8916as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8917format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8918
8919 Example :
8920 listen www
8921 mode http
8922 log global
8923 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8924
8925 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8926 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8927 (www/HTTP)
8928
8929 Field Format Extract from the example above
8930 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8931 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8932 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8933 4 'to' to
8934 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8935 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8936
8937Detailed fields description :
8938 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8939 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8940 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8941 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8942 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8943 and processed the connection.
8944 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8945
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008946In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8947"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8948connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8949
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008950It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8951will eventually disappear.
8952
8953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089548.2.2. TCP log format
8955---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008956
8957The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8958is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8959information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8960counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8961emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8962environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8963the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8964sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008965specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8966not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8967fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8968marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008969
8970 Example :
8971 frontend fnt
8972 mode tcp
8973 option tcplog
8974 log global
8975 default_backend bck
8976
8977 backend bck
8978 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8979
8980 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8981 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8982 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8983
8984 Field Format Extract from the example above
8985 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8986 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8987 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8988 4 frontend_name fnt
8989 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8990 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8991 7 bytes_read* 212
8992 8 termination_state --
8993 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8994 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8995
8996Detailed fields description :
8997 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008998 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8999 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9000 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9001 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9002 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009003
9004 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009005 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9006 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9007 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009008
9009 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9010 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9011 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9012 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9013
9014 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9015 and processed the connection.
9016
9017 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9018 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9019 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9020 applications.
9021
9022 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9023 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9024 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9025 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9026 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9027
9028 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9029 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9030 See "Timers" below for more details.
9031
9032 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9033 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9034 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9035 "Timers" below for more details.
9036
9037 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9038 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9039 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9040 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9041 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9042 details.
9043
9044 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9045 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9046 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9047 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9048 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9049
9050 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9051 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9052 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9053 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9054 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9055 for more details.
9056
9057 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009058 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009059 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9060 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9061 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009062 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009063
9064 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9065 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9066 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9067 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9068 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9069 caused by a denial of service attack.
9070
9071 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9072 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9073 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9074 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9075 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9076 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9077 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9078 denial of service attack.
9079
9080 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9081 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9082 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9083 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9084 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9085 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9086 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9087 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9088 be processed than on other servers.
9089
9090 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9091 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9092 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9093 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9094 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9095 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9096 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9097 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9098 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9099 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9100 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9101 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9102 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9103
9104 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9105 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9106 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9107 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9108 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9109 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9110 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9111 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9112
9113 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9114 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9115 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9116 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9117 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9118 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9119 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9120 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9121 occurs.
9122
9123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091248.2.3. HTTP log format
9125----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009126
9127The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9128is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9129the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9130are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9131emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9132generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9133"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9134which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009135frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9136is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009137
9138Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9139slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9140with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9141
9142 Example :
9143 frontend http-in
9144 mode http
9145 option httplog
9146 log global
9147 default_backend bck
9148
9149 backend static
9150 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9151
9152 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9153 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9154 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009155 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009156
9157 Field Format Extract from the example above
9158 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9159 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9160 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9161 4 frontend_name http-in
9162 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9163 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9164 7 status_code 200
9165 8 bytes_read* 2750
9166 9 captured_request_cookie -
9167 10 captured_response_cookie -
9168 11 termination_state ----
9169 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9170 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9171 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9172 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9173 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009174
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009175
9176Detailed fields description :
9177 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009178 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9179 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9180 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9181 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9182 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009183
9184 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009185 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9186 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9187 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009188
9189 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9190 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9191 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9192 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9193 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9194
9195 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9196 and processed the connection.
9197
9198 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9199 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9200 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9201
9202 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9203 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9204 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9205 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9206 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9207 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9208
9209 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9210 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9211 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9212 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9213 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9214 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9215
9216 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9217 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9218 See "Timers" below for more details.
9219
9220 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9221 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9222 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9223 below for more details.
9224
9225 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9226 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9227 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9228 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9229 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9230 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9231 for more details.
9232
9233 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9234 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9235 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9236 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9237 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9238 details.
9239
9240 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9241 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9242 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9243
9244 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9245 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9246 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9247 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9248 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9249 overflowing.
9250
9251 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9252 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9253 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9254 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9255 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9256 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9257 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9258 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9259
9260 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9261 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9262 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9263 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9264 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9265 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9266 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9267 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9268
9269 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9270 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9271 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9272 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9273 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9274 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9275 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9276
9277 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009278 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009279 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9280 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9281 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009282 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009283 system.
9284
9285 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9286 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9287 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9288 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9289 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9290 caused by a denial of service attack.
9291
9292 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9293 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9294 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9295 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9296 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9297 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9298 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9299 denial of service attack.
9300
9301 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9302 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9303 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9304 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9305 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9306 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9307 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9308 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9309 processed than on other servers.
9310
9311 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9312 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9313 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9314 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9315 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9316 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9317 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9318 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9319 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9320 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9321 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9322 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9323 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9324
9325 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9326 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9327 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9328 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9329 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9330 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9331 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9332 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9333
9334 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9335 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9336 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9337 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9338 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9339 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9340 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9341 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9342 occurs.
9343
9344 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9345 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9346 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9347 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9348 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9349 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9350 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9351 cookies" below for more details.
9352
9353 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9354 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9355 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9356 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9357 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9358 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9359 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9360 and cookies" below for more details.
9361
9362 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9363 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9364 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9365 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9366 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9367 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9368 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9369 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9370
9371
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020093728.2.4. Custom log format
9373------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009374
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009375The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
9376mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009377
9378HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
9379Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
9380separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
9381prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
9382
9383Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
9384variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
9385string formats ("Q").
9386
9387Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
9388HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
9389
9390Flags are :
9391 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009392 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009393
9394 Example:
9395
9396 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
9397 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
9398
9399At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
9400
9401 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009402 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009403
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009404the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009405
9406 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009407 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009408 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
9409
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009410and the default TCP format is defined this way :
9411
9412 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
9413 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
9414
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009415Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
9416
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009417 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9418 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
9419 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9420 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
9421 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9422 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009423 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009424 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009425 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01009426 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009427 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
9428 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
9429 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009430 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009431 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
9432 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
9433 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009434 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
9435 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
9436 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009437 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009438 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
9439 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
9440 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
9441 | | %b | backend_name | string |
9442 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
9443 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
9444 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009445 | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009446 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
9447 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
9448 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
9449 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
9450 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
9451 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9452 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
9453 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009454 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009455 | * | %r | http_request | string |
9456 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9457 | | %s | server_name | string |
9458 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9459 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
9460 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009461 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009462 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009463 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009464 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009465
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009466*: mode http only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094688.3. Advanced logging options
9469-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009470
9471Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9472just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9473options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9474for more information about their usage.
9475
9476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094778.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9478------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009479
9480It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9481haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9482commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9483monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9484ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9485
9486 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9487 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9488 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9489 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9490
9491 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9492 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9493 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9494 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9495 such as other load-balancers.
9496
9497 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9498 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9499 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9500
9501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095028.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9503----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009504
9505The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9506what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9507or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9508"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9509just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9510log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9511after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9512is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9513with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9514with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9515
9516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095178.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9518------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009519
9520Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9521for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9522"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9523retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9524raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9525a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9526file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9527you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9528"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9529
9530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095318.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9532--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009533
9534Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9535multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9536them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9537"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9538logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9539error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9540and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9541too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9542useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9543alternative.
9544
9545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095468.4. Timing events
9547------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009548
9549Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9550reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9551the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9552frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9553mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9554
9555 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9556 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9557 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9558 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9559 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9560
9561 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9562 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9563 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9564 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9565 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9566
9567 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9568 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9569 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9570 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9571 connection never established.
9572
9573 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9574 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9575 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9576 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9577 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9578 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9579 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9580 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9581 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9582 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9583 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9584
9585 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9586 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9587 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9588 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9589 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9590
9591 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9592
9593 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9594 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9595 negative.
9596
9597These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9598protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9599that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009600due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009601close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9602session has been aborted on timeout.
9603
9604Most common cases :
9605
9606 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9607 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9608 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9609 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9610 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9611 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9612 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9613 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9614 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009615 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9616 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9617 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009618
9619 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9620 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9621 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9622 of ms on remote networks.
9623
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009624 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9625 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9626 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009627
9628 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9629 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9630 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9631 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9632 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9633 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9634 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9635 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9636 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9637 to the server until another one is released.
9638
9639Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9640
9641 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9642 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9643 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9644
9645 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9646 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9647 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9648
9649 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9650 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9651 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9652 flags.
9653
9654 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9655 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9656 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9657 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9658 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9659 the client connection was maintained open.
9660
9661 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9662 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9663 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9664 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9665
9666
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096678.5. Session state at disconnection
9668-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009669
9670TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9671"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
96722-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9673each of which has a special meaning :
9674
9675 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9676 session to terminate :
9677
9678 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9679
9680 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9681 server explicitly refused it.
9682
9683 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9684 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9685 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9686 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9687 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9688 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9689
9690 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9691 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9692 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9693 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9694 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9695
9696 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9697 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9698 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9699 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9700 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9701
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009702 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9703 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9704
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009705 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
9706 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
9707 backup connections when going up.
9708
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009709 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9710
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009711 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9712 send or receive data.
9713
9714 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9715 send or receive data.
9716
9717 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9718 with nothing left in the buffers.
9719
9720 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9721
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009722 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009723 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9724
9725 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9726 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9727 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9728 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9729 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9730
9731 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9732 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9733
9734 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9735 server (HTTP only).
9736
9737 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9738
9739 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9740 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9741 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9742
9743 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9744 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9745 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9746
9747 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9748
9749 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9750 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9751
9752 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9753 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9754 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9755
9756 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9757 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009758 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9759 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009760
9761 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9762 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9763 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9764 another server.
9765
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009766 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009767 server.
9768
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009769 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9770 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9771 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9772 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9773
9774 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9775 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9776 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9777 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9778
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +02009779 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
9780 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
9781 "use-server" rule).
9782
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009783 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9784
9785 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9786 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9787
9788 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9789
9790 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9791 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9792 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9793
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009794 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9795 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9796 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9797 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9798 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9799
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009800 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9801
9802 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9803 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9804
9805 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9806
9807 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9808
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009809The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9810was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009811helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9812starvation, attacks, etc...
9813
9814The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9815alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9816easier finding and understanding.
9817
9818 Flags Reason
9819
9820 -- Normal termination.
9821
9822 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9823 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9824 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9825 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9826
9827 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9828 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9829 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9830 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9831 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9832 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009833
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009834 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9835 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009836 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009837
9838 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9839 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9840 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9841
9842 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9843 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9844 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9845 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9846 the server takes too long to respond.
9847
9848 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9849 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9850 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9851 long a time to respond.
9852
9853 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9854 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9855 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9856 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9857 and the client.
9858
9859 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9860 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9861 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9862 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9863 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9864 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9865
9866 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9867 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009868 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9869 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9870 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9871 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009873 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009874 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9875 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9876 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9877 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9878 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9879
9880 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9881 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9882 503 or 504 here.
9883
9884 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9885 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9886 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9887 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9888 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9889
9890 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9891 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009892 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009893 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9894 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9895
9896 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9897 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9898 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9899 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9900 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9901 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9902 between haproxy and the server.
9903
9904 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9905 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9906 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9907 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9908 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9909 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9910 solution is to fix the application.
9911
9912 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9913 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9914 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9915 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9916 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9917 external attacks.
9918
9919 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9920 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009921 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009922 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9923 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9924
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009925 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9926 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9927 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9928 the client.
9929
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009930 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9931 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9932 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9933 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009934 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9935 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9936 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9937 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9938 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009939
9940 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9941 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9942 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9943 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9944
9945 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9946 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9947 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9948 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9949
9950 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9951 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9952 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9953 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9954
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009955The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9956persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9957important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9958re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9959
9960 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9961
9962 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9963 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9964 set on a GET request.
9965
9966 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9967 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009968 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009969 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9970
9971 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9972 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9973 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9974
9975 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9976 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9977 already got a cookie.
9978
9979 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9980 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9981 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9982 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9983 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9984
9985 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9986 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9987 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9988
9989 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9990 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9991 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9992
9993 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9994 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9995
9996 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9997 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9998 then advertised in the response.
9999
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100018.6. Non-printable characters
10002-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010003
10004In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10005consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10006converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10007prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10008being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10009escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10010is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10011'}' when logging headers.
10012
10013Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10014issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10015containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10016
10017Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10018the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10019performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10020
10021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100228.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10023---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010024
10025Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10026achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010027section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010028cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10029the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10030the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010031locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010032not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10033user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10034a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10035wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10036
10037 Examples :
10038 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10039 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10040
10041 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10042 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10043
10044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100458.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10046---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010047
10048Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10049proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10050the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10051server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10052
10053Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10054response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010055section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010056
10057It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010058time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10059appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010060are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10061and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10062follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10063request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10064in the logs.
10065
10066 Example :
10067 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10068 listen proxy-out
10069 mode http
10070 option httplog
10071 option logasap
10072 log global
10073 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10074
10075 # log the name of the virtual server
10076 capture request header Host len 20
10077
10078 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10079 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10080
10081 # log the beginning of the referrer
10082 capture request header Referer len 20
10083
10084 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10085 capture response header Server len 20
10086
10087 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10088 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10089
10090 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10091 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10092
10093 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10094 capture response header Via len 20
10095
10096 # log the URL location during a redirection
10097 capture response header Location len 20
10098
10099 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10100 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10101 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10102 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10103 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10104
10105 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10106 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10107 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10108 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010109 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010110
10111 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10112 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10113 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10114 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10115 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010116 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010117
10118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101198.9. Examples of logs
10120---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010121
10122These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10123them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10124reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10125
10126 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10127 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10128 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10129
10130 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10131 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10132
10133 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10134 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10135 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10136
10137 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10138 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10139
10140 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10141 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10142 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10143
10144 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010145 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010146 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10147 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10148
10149 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10150 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10151 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10152
10153 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10154 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010155 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010156 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10157 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10158 to return the 502 and not the server.
10159
10160 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010161 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010162
10163 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10164 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10165 Nothing was sent to any server.
10166
10167 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10168 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10169
10170 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10171 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10172 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10173 send a 408 return code to the client.
10174
10175 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10176 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10177
10178 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10179 5 seconds ("c----").
10180
10181 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10182 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010183 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010184
10185 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010186 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010187 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10188 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10189 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10190 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10191 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010192
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101949. Statistics and monitoring
10195----------------------------
10196
10197It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10198mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10199CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10200Unix socket.
10201
10202
102039.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010204---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010205
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010206The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10207page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10208
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010209 0. pxname: proxy name
10210 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10211 for server)
10212 2. qcur: current queued requests
10213 3. qmax: max queued requests
10214 4. scur: current sessions
10215 5. smax: max sessions
10216 6. slim: sessions limit
10217 7. stot: total sessions
10218 8. bin: bytes in
10219 9. bout: bytes out
10220 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010221 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010222 12. ereq: request errors
10223 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010224 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010225 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10226 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010227 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010228 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10229 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10230 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10231 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10232 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10233 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10234 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10235 25. qlimit: queue limit
10236 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10237 27. iid: unique proxy id
10238 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10239 29. throttle: warm up status
10240 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10241 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010242 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010243 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10244 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10245 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010246 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010247 UNK -> unknown
10248 INI -> initializing
10249 SOCKERR -> socket error
10250 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10251 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10252 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10253 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10254 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10255 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10256 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10257 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10258 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10259 disable-on-404
10260 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10261 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10262 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010263 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10264 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010265 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10266 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10267 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10268 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10269 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10270 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010271 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10272 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10273 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10274 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010275 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10276 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010277
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102799.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010280-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010281
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010282The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010283must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10284is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10285a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10286risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10287followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10288given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10289then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10290to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010291
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010292It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10293on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10294own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010295
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010296clear counters
10297 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10298 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10299 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10300 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10301 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10302
10303clear counters all
10304 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10305 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10306 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10307
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010308clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10309 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10310
10311 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10312 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10313 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10314 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10315 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10316 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10317
10318 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10319
10320 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10321 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10322 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10323 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10324 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10325 the ACLs :
10326
10327 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10328 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10329 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10330 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10331 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10332 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10333
10334 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010335 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10336 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010337
10338 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010339 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010340 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010341 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10342 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10343 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10344 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010345
10346 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10347
10348 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010349 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010350 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10351 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010352 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10353 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10354 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010355
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010356disable frontend <frontend>
10357 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10358 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10359 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10360 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10361 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10362 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10363 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10364 on the stats page.
10365
10366 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10367 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10368
10369 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10370 level "admin".
10371
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010372disable server <backend>/<server>
10373 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
10374 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
10375 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
10376 during the maintenance.
10377
10378 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
10379 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
10380
10381 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010382 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010383
10384 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10385 level "admin".
10386
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010387enable frontend <frontend>
10388 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
10389 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
10390 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
10391 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
10392 which was disabled.
10393
10394 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10395 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10396
10397 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10398 level "admin".
10399
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010400enable server <backend>/<server>
10401 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
10402 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
10403
10404 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010405 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010406
10407 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10408 level "admin".
10409
10410get weight <backend>/<server>
10411 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
10412 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
10413 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
10414 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
10415 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010416 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010417
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010418help
10419 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
10420 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010421
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010422prompt
10423 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
10424 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
10425 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
10426 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
10427 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
10428 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
10429 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
10430 command.
10431
10432quit
10433 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010434
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010435set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
10436 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
10437 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
10438 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
10439 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10440 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10441 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
10442 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10443
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020010444set maxconn global <maxconn>
10445 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
10446 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
10447 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10448 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10449 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
10450 setting.
10451
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020010452set rate-limit connections global <value>
10453 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
10454 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
10455 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10456 is passed in number of connections per second.
10457
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020010458set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
10459 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
10460 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
10461 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
10462 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
10463 IP address or affect its quality of service.
10464
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010465set timeout cli <delay>
10466 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10467 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10468 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10469
10470set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10471 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10472 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10473 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10474 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10475 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10476 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10477 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10478 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10479 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10480 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10481 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10482 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10483 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010484 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010485
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010486show errors [<iid>]
10487 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10488 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010489 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10490 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10491 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010492
10493 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10494 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10495 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10496 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10497 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10498 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10499 are reported too.
10500
10501 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10502 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10503 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10504 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10505 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10506 code.
10507
10508 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10509 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10510 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10511 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10512 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10513 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10514 line.
10515
10516 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010517 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10518 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010519 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10520 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10521
10522 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10523 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10524 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10525 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10526 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10527 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10528 00204+ minal\r\n
10529 00211 \r\n
10530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010531 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010532 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10533 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10534 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10535 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10536 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10537 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010538
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010539show info
10540 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10541
10542show sess
10543 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010544 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10545 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10546
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010547show sess <id>
10548 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10549 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10550 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10551 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10552 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10553 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010554
10555show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10556 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10557 possible to dump only selected items :
10558 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10559 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10560 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10561 for example:
10562 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10563 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10564 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10565
10566 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010567 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10568 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010569 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10570 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10571 Nbproc: 1
10572 Process_num: 1
10573 (...)
10574
10575 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10576 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10577 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10578 (...)
10579 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10580
10581 $
10582
10583 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10584 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10585 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10586 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010587 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010588
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010589show table
10590 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10591 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10592 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10593 entries currently in use.
10594
10595 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010596 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010597 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10598 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010599
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010600show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010601 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10602 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10603 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010604 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10605
10606 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10607 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10608 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10609 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10610 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10611
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010612 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10613 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10614 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10615 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10616 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10617 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10618
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010619
10620 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010621 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10622 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010623
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010624 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010625 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010626 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010627 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10628 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10629 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10630 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010631
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010632 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010633 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010634 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10635 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010636
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010637 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10638 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010639 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010640 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10641 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010642
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010643 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10644 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010645 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010646 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10647 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10648
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010649 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10650 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10651 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10652 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10653 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10654
10655 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10656 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10657 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010658 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10659 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010660 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10661 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010662
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010663shutdown frontend <frontend>
10664 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10665 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10666 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10667 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10668 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10669 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10670 once it is terminated.
10671
10672 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10673 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10674
10675 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10676 level "admin".
10677
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010678shutdown session <id>
10679 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10680 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10681 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10682 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10683 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10684 flag in the logs.
10685
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010686shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10687 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10688 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10689 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10690 'K' flag in the logs.
10691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010692/*
10693 * Local variables:
10694 * fill-column: 79
10695 * End:
10696 */